1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading ---------------------*- C++ -*-===//
2 //
3 //                     The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4 //
5 // This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6 // License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
7 //
8 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9 //
10 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
11 //
12 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13 
14 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
15 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
16 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
17 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
18 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
19 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
20 #include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
21 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
22 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
23 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
24 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
25 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
26 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
27 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
28 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
29 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
30 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
31 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
32 #include <algorithm>
33 
34 namespace clang {
35 using namespace sema;
36 
37 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a
38 /// function.
39 static ExprResult
40 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
41                       SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
42                       const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
43   DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context) DeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(),
44                                                  VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
45   if (HadMultipleCandidates)
46     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
47   ExprResult E = S.Owned(DRE);
48   E = S.DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E.take());
49   if (E.isInvalid())
50     return ExprError();
51   return move(E);
52 }
53 
54 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
55                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
56                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
57                                  bool CStyle,
58                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
59 
60 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
61                                                  QualType &ToType,
62                                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
63                                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
64                                                  bool CStyle);
65 static OverloadingResult
66 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
67                         UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
68                         OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
69                         bool AllowExplicit);
70 
71 
72 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
73 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
74                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
75                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
76 
77 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
78 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
79                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
80                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
81 
82 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
83 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
84                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
85                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
86 
87 
88 
89 /// GetConversionCategory - Retrieve the implicit conversion
90 /// category corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
91 ImplicitConversionCategory
92 GetConversionCategory(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
93   static const ImplicitConversionCategory
94     Category[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
95     ICC_Identity,
96     ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
97     ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
98     ICC_Lvalue_Transformation,
99     ICC_Identity,
100     ICC_Qualification_Adjustment,
101     ICC_Promotion,
102     ICC_Promotion,
103     ICC_Promotion,
104     ICC_Conversion,
105     ICC_Conversion,
106     ICC_Conversion,
107     ICC_Conversion,
108     ICC_Conversion,
109     ICC_Conversion,
110     ICC_Conversion,
111     ICC_Conversion,
112     ICC_Conversion,
113     ICC_Conversion,
114     ICC_Conversion,
115     ICC_Conversion,
116     ICC_Conversion
117   };
118   return Category[(int)Kind];
119 }
120 
121 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
122 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
123 ImplicitConversionRank GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
124   static const ImplicitConversionRank
125     Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
126     ICR_Exact_Match,
127     ICR_Exact_Match,
128     ICR_Exact_Match,
129     ICR_Exact_Match,
130     ICR_Exact_Match,
131     ICR_Exact_Match,
132     ICR_Promotion,
133     ICR_Promotion,
134     ICR_Promotion,
135     ICR_Conversion,
136     ICR_Conversion,
137     ICR_Conversion,
138     ICR_Conversion,
139     ICR_Conversion,
140     ICR_Conversion,
141     ICR_Conversion,
142     ICR_Conversion,
143     ICR_Conversion,
144     ICR_Conversion,
145     ICR_Conversion,
146     ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
147     ICR_Conversion,
148     ICR_Conversion,
149     ICR_Writeback_Conversion
150   };
151   return Rank[(int)Kind];
152 }
153 
154 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
155 /// implicit conversion.
156 const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
157   static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
158     "No conversion",
159     "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
160     "Array-to-pointer",
161     "Function-to-pointer",
162     "Noreturn adjustment",
163     "Qualification",
164     "Integral promotion",
165     "Floating point promotion",
166     "Complex promotion",
167     "Integral conversion",
168     "Floating conversion",
169     "Complex conversion",
170     "Floating-integral conversion",
171     "Pointer conversion",
172     "Pointer-to-member conversion",
173     "Boolean conversion",
174     "Compatible-types conversion",
175     "Derived-to-base conversion",
176     "Vector conversion",
177     "Vector splat",
178     "Complex-real conversion",
179     "Block Pointer conversion",
180     "Transparent Union Conversion"
181     "Writeback conversion"
182   };
183   return Name[Kind];
184 }
185 
186 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
187 /// sequence to the identity conversion.
188 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
189   First = ICK_Identity;
190   Second = ICK_Identity;
191   Third = ICK_Identity;
192   DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
193   QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
194   ReferenceBinding = false;
195   DirectBinding = false;
196   IsLvalueReference = true;
197   BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
198   BindsToRvalue = false;
199   BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
200   ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
201   CopyConstructor = 0;
202 }
203 
204 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
205 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
206 /// implicit conversions.
207 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
208   ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
209   if  (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
210     Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
211   if  (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
212     Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
213   if  (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
214     Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
215   return Rank;
216 }
217 
218 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
219 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
220 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
221 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
222 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
223   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
224   // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
225   // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
226   // a pointer.
227   if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
228       (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
229        getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
230        getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
231        getFromType()->isNullPtrType() ||
232        First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
233     return true;
234 
235   return false;
236 }
237 
238 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
239 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
240 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
241 /// 13.3.3.2p4).
242 bool
243 StandardConversionSequence::
244 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
245   QualType FromType = getFromType();
246   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
247 
248   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
249   // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
250   // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
251   if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
252     FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
253 
254   if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
255     if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
256       return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
257 
258   return false;
259 }
260 
261 /// DebugPrint - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
262 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
263 void StandardConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
264   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
265   bool PrintedSomething = false;
266   if (First != ICK_Identity) {
267     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
268     PrintedSomething = true;
269   }
270 
271   if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
272     if (PrintedSomething) {
273       OS << " -> ";
274     }
275     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
276 
277     if (CopyConstructor) {
278       OS << " (by copy constructor)";
279     } else if (DirectBinding) {
280       OS << " (direct reference binding)";
281     } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
282       OS << " (reference binding)";
283     }
284     PrintedSomething = true;
285   }
286 
287   if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
288     if (PrintedSomething) {
289       OS << " -> ";
290     }
291     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
292     PrintedSomething = true;
293   }
294 
295   if (!PrintedSomething) {
296     OS << "No conversions required";
297   }
298 }
299 
300 /// DebugPrint - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
301 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
302 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
303   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
304   if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
305     Before.DebugPrint();
306     OS << " -> ";
307   }
308   OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
309   if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
310     OS << " -> ";
311     After.DebugPrint();
312   }
313 }
314 
315 /// DebugPrint - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
316 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
317 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DebugPrint() const {
318   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
319   switch (ConversionKind) {
320   case StandardConversion:
321     OS << "Standard conversion: ";
322     Standard.DebugPrint();
323     break;
324   case UserDefinedConversion:
325     OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
326     UserDefined.DebugPrint();
327     break;
328   case EllipsisConversion:
329     OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
330     break;
331   case AmbiguousConversion:
332     OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
333     break;
334   case BadConversion:
335     OS << "Bad conversion";
336     break;
337   }
338 
339   OS << "\n";
340 }
341 
342 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
343   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
344 }
345 
346 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
347   conversions().~ConversionSet();
348 }
349 
350 void
351 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
352   FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
353   ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
354   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
355 }
356 
357 namespace {
358   // Structure used by OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo to store
359   // template parameter and template argument information.
360   struct DFIParamWithArguments {
361     TemplateParameter Param;
362     TemplateArgument FirstArg;
363     TemplateArgument SecondArg;
364   };
365 }
366 
367 /// \brief Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
368 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
369 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo
370 static MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
371                                 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
372                                 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
373   OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo Result;
374   Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
375   Result.Data = 0;
376   switch (TDK) {
377   case Sema::TDK_Success:
378   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
379   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
380   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
381     break;
382 
383   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
384   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
385     Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
386     break;
387 
388   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
389   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
390     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
391     DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
392     Saved->Param = Info.Param;
393     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
394     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
395     Result.Data = Saved;
396     break;
397   }
398 
399   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
400     Result.Data = Info.take();
401     break;
402 
403   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
404   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
405     break;
406   }
407 
408   return Result;
409 }
410 
411 void OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
412   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
413   case Sema::TDK_Success:
414   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
415   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
416   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
417   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
418   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
419     break;
420 
421   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
422   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
423     // FIXME: Destroy the data?
424     Data = 0;
425     break;
426 
427   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
428     // FIXME: Destroy the template arugment list?
429     Data = 0;
430     break;
431 
432   // Unhandled
433   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
434   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
435     break;
436   }
437 }
438 
439 TemplateParameter
440 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
441   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
442   case Sema::TDK_Success:
443   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
444   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
445   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
446   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
447     return TemplateParameter();
448 
449   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
450   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
451     return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
452 
453   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
454   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
455     return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
456 
457   // Unhandled
458   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
459   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
460     break;
461   }
462 
463   return TemplateParameter();
464 }
465 
466 TemplateArgumentList *
467 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
468   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
469     case Sema::TDK_Success:
470     case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
471     case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
472     case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
473     case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
474     case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
475     case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
476     case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
477       return 0;
478 
479     case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
480       return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
481 
482     // Unhandled
483     case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
484     case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
485       break;
486   }
487 
488   return 0;
489 }
490 
491 const TemplateArgument *OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
492   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
493   case Sema::TDK_Success:
494   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
495   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
496   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
497   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
498   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
499   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
500     return 0;
501 
502   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
503   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
504     return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
505 
506   // Unhandled
507   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
508   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
509     break;
510   }
511 
512   return 0;
513 }
514 
515 const TemplateArgument *
516 OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
517   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
518   case Sema::TDK_Success:
519   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
520   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
521   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
522   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
523   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
524   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
525     return 0;
526 
527   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
528   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
529     return &static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
530 
531   // Unhandled
532   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
533   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
534     break;
535   }
536 
537   return 0;
538 }
539 
540 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear() {
541   inherited::clear();
542   Functions.clear();
543 }
544 
545 namespace {
546   class UnbridgedCastsSet {
547     struct Entry {
548       Expr **Addr;
549       Expr *Saved;
550     };
551     SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
552 
553   public:
554     void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
555       assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
556       Entry entry = { &E, E };
557       Entries.push_back(entry);
558       E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
559     }
560 
561     void restore() {
562       for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
563              i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
564         *i->Addr = i->Saved;
565     }
566   };
567 }
568 
569 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
570 /// preprocessing on the given expression.
571 ///
572 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
573 ///   without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
574 ///
575 /// Return true on unrecoverable error.
576 static bool checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
577                                         UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = 0) {
578   // ObjCProperty l-values are placeholder-like.
579   if (E->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
580     ExprResult result = S.ConvertPropertyForRValue(E);
581     if (result.isInvalid())
582       return true;
583 
584     E = result.take();
585     return false;
586   }
587 
588   // Handle true placeholders.
589   if (const BuiltinType *placeholder =  E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
590     // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
591     // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
592     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
593 
594     // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
595     // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
596     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
597         unbridgedCasts) {
598       unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
599       return false;
600     }
601 
602     // Go ahead and check everything else.
603     ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
604     if (result.isInvalid())
605       return true;
606 
607     E = result.take();
608     return false;
609   }
610 
611   // Nothing to do.
612   return false;
613 }
614 
615 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
616 /// placeholders.
617 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S, Expr **args,
618                                             unsigned numArgs,
619                                             UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
620   for (unsigned i = 0; i != numArgs; ++i)
621     if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, args[i], &unbridged))
622       return true;
623 
624   return false;
625 }
626 
627 // IsOverload - Determine whether the given New declaration is an
628 // overload of the declarations in Old. This routine returns false if
629 // New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same
630 // signature as some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old
631 // declarations aren't functions (or function templates) at all. When
632 // it does return false, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New
633 // cannot be overloaded with.  This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on
634 // top of the underlying declaration.
635 //
636 // Example: Given the following input:
637 //
638 //   void f(int, float); // #1
639 //   void f(int, int); // #2
640 //   int f(int, int); // #3
641 //
642 // When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f",
643 // so IsOverload will not be used.
644 //
645 // When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1.  By
646 // comparing the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded
647 // (since they have different signatures), so this routine returns
648 // false; MatchedDecl is unchanged.
649 //
650 // When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We
651 // compare the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do
652 // nothing) and then #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are
653 // identical (return types of functions are not part of the
654 // signature), IsOverload returns false and MatchedDecl will be set to
655 // point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
656 //
657 // 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced
658 // into a class by a using declaration.  The rules for whether to hide
659 // shadow declarations ignore some properties which otherwise figure
660 // into a function template's signature.
661 Sema::OverloadKind
662 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
663                     NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
664   for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
665          I != E; ++I) {
666     NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
667 
668     bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
669     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
670       OldIsUsingDecl = true;
671 
672       // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
673       // context, even if they have identical signatures.
674       if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
675 
676       OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
677     }
678 
679     // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
680     // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
681     // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
682     // function templates hide function templates with different
683     // return types or template parameter lists.
684     bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
685       (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord();
686 
687     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *OldT = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD)) {
688       if (!IsOverload(New, OldT->getTemplatedDecl(), UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
689         if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
690           HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
691           continue;
692         }
693 
694         Match = *I;
695         return Ovl_Match;
696       }
697     } else if (FunctionDecl *OldF = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(OldD)) {
698       if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
699         if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
700           HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
701           continue;
702         }
703 
704         Match = *I;
705         return Ovl_Match;
706       }
707     } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD)) {
708       // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
709       // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
710       assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
711     } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
712       // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
713     } else if (isa<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
714       // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
715       // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
716       // template instantiation.
717     } else {
718       // (C++ 13p1):
719       //   Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
720       //   declarations cannot be overloaded.
721       Match = *I;
722       return Ovl_NonFunction;
723     }
724   }
725 
726   return Ovl_Overload;
727 }
728 
729 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
730                       bool UseUsingDeclRules) {
731   // If both of the functions are extern "C", then they are not
732   // overloads.
733   if (Old->isExternC() && New->isExternC())
734     return false;
735 
736   FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
737   FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
738 
739   // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
740   //   A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
741   //   and with normal (non-template) functions.
742   if ((OldTemplate == 0) != (NewTemplate == 0))
743     return true;
744 
745   // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
746   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
747   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
748 
749   // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
750   // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
751   // in the signature, they are overloads.
752 
753   // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
754   // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
755   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
756       isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
757     return false;
758 
759   const FunctionProtoType* OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
760   const FunctionProtoType* NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
761 
762   // The signature of a function includes the types of its
763   // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
764   // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
765   if (OldQType != NewQType &&
766       (OldType->getNumArgs() != NewType->getNumArgs() ||
767        OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
768        !FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
769     return true;
770 
771   // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
772   //   The signature of a function template consists of its function
773   //   signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
774   //   of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
775   //   relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
776   //   signature.
777   //
778   // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
779   // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
780   //
781   // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
782   // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
783   if (!UseUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
784       (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
785                                        OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
786                                        false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
787        OldType->getResultType() != NewType->getResultType()))
788     return true;
789 
790   // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
791   // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
792   //
793   // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
794   // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
795   // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
796   // this check is important to determine whether these functions
797   // can be overloaded.
798   CXXMethodDecl* OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
799   CXXMethodDecl* NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
800   if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
801       !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic() &&
802       (OldMethod->getTypeQualifiers() != NewMethod->getTypeQualifiers() ||
803        OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier())) {
804     if (!UseUsingDeclRules &&
805         OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier() &&
806         (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
807          NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
808       // C++0x [over.load]p2:
809       //   - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
810       //     parameter-type-list as well as member function template
811       //     declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
812       //     the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
813       //     them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
814       Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
815         << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
816       Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
817     }
818 
819     return true;
820   }
821 
822   // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
823   return false;
824 }
825 
826 /// \brief Checks availability of the function depending on the current
827 /// function context. Inside an unavailable function, unavailability is ignored.
828 ///
829 /// \returns true if \arg FD is unavailable and current context is inside
830 /// an available function, false otherwise.
831 bool Sema::isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(FunctionDecl *FD) {
832   return FD->isUnavailable() && !cast<Decl>(CurContext)->isUnavailable();
833 }
834 
835 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
836 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
837 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
838 /// to perform the initialization. Given
839 ///
840 ///   void f(float f);
841 ///   void g(int i) { f(i); }
842 ///
843 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
844 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
845 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
846 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
847 //
848 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
849 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
850 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
851 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
852 /// "BadConversion".
853 ///
854 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
855 /// not permitted.
856 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
857 /// permitted.
858 ///
859 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
860 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
861 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
862 static ImplicitConversionSequence
863 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
864                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
865                       bool AllowExplicit,
866                       bool InOverloadResolution,
867                       bool CStyle,
868                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
869   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
870   if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
871                            ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
872     ICS.setStandard();
873     return ICS;
874   }
875 
876   if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
877     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
878     return ICS;
879   }
880 
881   // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
882   //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
883   //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
884   //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
885   //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
886   //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
887   //   called for those cases.
888   QualType FromType = From->getType();
889   if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
890       (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
891        S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ToType))) {
892     ICS.setStandard();
893     ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
894     ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
895     ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
896 
897     // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
898     // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
899     // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
900     // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
901     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
902 
903     // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
904     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
905       ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
906 
907     return ICS;
908   }
909 
910   if (SuppressUserConversions) {
911     // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
912     // we can perform.
913     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
914     return ICS;
915   }
916 
917   // Attempt user-defined conversion.
918   OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc());
919   OverloadingResult UserDefResult
920     = IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined, Conversions,
921                               AllowExplicit);
922 
923   if (UserDefResult == OR_Success) {
924     ICS.setUserDefined();
925     // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
926     //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
927     //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
928     //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
929     //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
930     //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
931     //   called for those cases.
932     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
933           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
934       QualType FromCanon
935         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
936       QualType ToCanon
937         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
938       if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
939           (FromCanon == ToCanon || S.IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
940         // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
941         // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
942         ICS.setStandard();
943         ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
944         ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
945         ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
946         ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
947         if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
948           ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
949       }
950     }
951 
952     // C++ [over.best.ics]p4:
953     //   However, when considering the argument of a user-defined
954     //   conversion function that is a candidate by 13.3.1.3 when
955     //   invoked for the copying of the temporary in the second step
956     //   of a class copy-initialization, or by 13.3.1.4, 13.3.1.5, or
957     //   13.3.1.6 in all cases, only standard conversion sequences and
958     //   ellipsis conversion sequences are allowed.
959     if (SuppressUserConversions && ICS.isUserDefined()) {
960       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::suppressed_user, From, ToType);
961     }
962   } else if (UserDefResult == OR_Ambiguous && !SuppressUserConversions) {
963     ICS.setAmbiguous();
964     ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
965     ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
966     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
967          Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
968       if (Cand->Viable)
969         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
970   } else {
971     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
972   }
973 
974   return ICS;
975 }
976 
977 ImplicitConversionSequence
978 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
979                             bool SuppressUserConversions,
980                             bool AllowExplicit,
981                             bool InOverloadResolution,
982                             bool CStyle,
983                             bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
984   return clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
985                                       SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit,
986                                       InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
987                                       AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
988 }
989 
990 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
991 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
992 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
993 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
994 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
995 ExprResult
996 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
997                                 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit) {
998   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
999   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, Action, AllowExplicit, ICS);
1000 }
1001 
1002 ExprResult
1003 Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1004                                 AssignmentAction Action, bool AllowExplicit,
1005                                 ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS) {
1006   // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1007   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1008     = getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1009       (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
1010 
1011   ICS = clang::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType,
1012                                      /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1013                                      AllowExplicit,
1014                                      /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
1015                                      /*CStyle=*/false,
1016                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
1017   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1018 }
1019 
1020 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1021 /// conversion that strips "noreturn" off the nested function type.
1022 bool Sema::IsNoReturnConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1023                                 QualType &ResultTy) {
1024   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1025     return false;
1026 
1027   // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1028   // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1029   //   - a pointer
1030   //   - a member pointer
1031   //   - a block pointer
1032   CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1033   CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1034   Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1035   if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1036   if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1037     if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1038       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1039       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1040     } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1041       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1042       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1043     } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1044       CanTo = CanTo.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1045       CanFrom = CanFrom.getAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1046     } else {
1047       return false;
1048     }
1049 
1050     TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1051     if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1052     if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1053       return false;
1054   }
1055 
1056   const FunctionType *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1057   FunctionType::ExtInfo EInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1058   if (!EInfo.getNoReturn()) return false;
1059 
1060   FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, EInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1061   assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1062   if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1063 
1064   ResultTy = ToType;
1065   return true;
1066 }
1067 
1068 /// \brief Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1069 /// vector conversion.
1070 ///
1071 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1072 /// conversion.
1073 static bool IsVectorConversion(ASTContext &Context, QualType FromType,
1074                                QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
1075   // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1076   // conversion.
1077   if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1078     return false;
1079 
1080   // Identical types require no conversions.
1081   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1082     return false;
1083 
1084   // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1085   if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1086     // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1087     // identity conversion.
1088     if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1089       return false;
1090 
1091     // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
1092     if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
1093       ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1094       return true;
1095     }
1096   }
1097 
1098   // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1099   // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1100   // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1101   //   same size
1102   if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1103     if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1104         (Context.getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
1105          (Context.getTypeSize(FromType) == Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
1106       ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1107       return true;
1108     }
1109   }
1110 
1111   return false;
1112 }
1113 
1114 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1115 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1116 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1117 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1118 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1119 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1120 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1121 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
1122 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1123                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
1124                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1125                                  bool CStyle,
1126                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1127   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1128 
1129   // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
1130   SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
1131   SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
1132   SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
1133   SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1134   SCS.CopyConstructor = 0;
1135 
1136   // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
1137   // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit
1138   if (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()) {
1139     if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1140       return false;
1141 
1142     // When we're overloading in C, we allow, as standard conversions,
1143   }
1144 
1145   // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1146   // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1147   // (C++ 4p1).
1148 
1149   if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1150     DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1151     if (FunctionDecl *Fn
1152           = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
1153                                                  AccessPair)) {
1154       // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1155       // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1156       FromType = Fn->getType();
1157 
1158       // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1159       // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1160       if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1161                       S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1162         QualType resultTy;
1163         // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1164         if (!S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType,
1165               S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1166           // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1167           if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1168             return false;
1169       }
1170 
1171       // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1172       // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1173       // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1174       // expression.
1175       CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1176       if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1177         assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1178                "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1179         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1180                == UO_AddrOf &&
1181                "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1182         const Type *ClassType
1183           = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1184         FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
1185       } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1186         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1187                UO_AddrOf &&
1188                "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1189         FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1190       }
1191 
1192       // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
1193       assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1194         FromType,
1195         S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
1196     } else {
1197       return false;
1198     }
1199   }
1200   // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1201   //   A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1202   //   be converted to a prvalue.
1203   bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
1204   if (argIsLValue &&
1205       !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
1206       S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1207     SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
1208 
1209     // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1210     // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
1211     // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1212     // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
1213     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1214   } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1215     // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
1216     SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
1217 
1218     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1219     // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1220     // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
1221     FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
1222 
1223     if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
1224       // This conversion is deprecated. (C++ D.4).
1225       SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
1226 
1227       // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1228       // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1229       // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1230       // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
1231       SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1232       SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1233       SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
1234       SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
1235       return true;
1236     }
1237   } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
1238     // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
1239     SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
1240 
1241     // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1242     // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1243     // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
1244     FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1245   } else {
1246     // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
1247     SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
1248   }
1249   SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
1250 
1251   // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1252   // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1253   // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1254   // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
1255   // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1256   // conversion.
1257   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
1258   ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
1259   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
1260     // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1261     // conversion to do.
1262     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1263   } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
1264     // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
1265     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
1266     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1267   } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1268     // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
1269     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
1270     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1271   } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1272     // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
1273     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1274     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1275   } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1276              (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1277               FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1278               FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1279               FromType->isMemberPointerType() ||
1280               FromType->isNullPtrType())) {
1281     // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1282     SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1283     FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
1284   } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1285              ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
1286     // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
1287     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
1288     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1289   } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isComplexType()) {
1290     // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
1291     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1292     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1293   } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1294              (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
1295     // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1296     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1297     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1298   } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
1299     // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1300     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1301     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1302   } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
1303               ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
1304              (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1305               ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
1306     // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
1307     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
1308     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1309   } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1310     SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1311   } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1312              S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1313     SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
1314   } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1315                                    FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1316     // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
1317     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
1318     SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
1319     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1320   } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1321                                          InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
1322     // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
1323     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
1324   } else if (IsVectorConversion(S.Context, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
1325     SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1326     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1327   } else if (!S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1328              S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
1329     // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
1330     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1331     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1332   } else if (S.IsNoReturnConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1333     // Treat a conversion that strips "noreturn" as an identity conversion.
1334     SCS.Second = ICK_NoReturn_Adjustment;
1335   } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1336                                              InOverloadResolution,
1337                                              SCS, CStyle)) {
1338     SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1339     FromType = ToType;
1340   } else {
1341     // No second conversion required.
1342     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1343   }
1344   SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
1345 
1346   QualType CanonFrom;
1347   QualType CanonTo;
1348   // The third conversion can be a qualification conversion (C++ 4p1).
1349   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1350   if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1351                                   ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
1352     SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1353     SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1354     FromType = ToType;
1355     CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1356     CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1357   } else {
1358     // No conversion required
1359     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1360 
1361     // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
1362     //   [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1363     //   subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1364     //   a conversion. [...]
1365     CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1366     CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1367     if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1368                                        == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
1369         (CanonFrom.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalCVRQualifiers()
1370          || CanonFrom.getObjCGCAttr() != CanonTo.getObjCGCAttr()
1371          || CanonFrom.getObjCLifetime() != CanonTo.getObjCLifetime())) {
1372       FromType = ToType;
1373       CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1374     }
1375   }
1376   SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
1377 
1378   // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1379   // this is a bad conversion sequence.
1380   if (CanonFrom != CanonTo)
1381     return false;
1382 
1383   return true;
1384 }
1385 
1386 static bool
1387 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
1388                                      QualType &ToType,
1389                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
1390                                      StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1391                                      bool CStyle) {
1392 
1393   const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
1394   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
1395     return false;
1396   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
1397   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
1398   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
1399   for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
1400        itend = UD->field_end();
1401        it != itend; ++it) {
1402     if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1403                              CStyle, /*ObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
1404       ToType = it->getType();
1405       return true;
1406     }
1407   }
1408   return false;
1409 }
1410 
1411 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
1412 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
1413 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
1414 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
1415 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
1416   const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
1417   // All integers are built-in.
1418   if (!To) {
1419     return false;
1420   }
1421 
1422   // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
1423   // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
1424   // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
1425   // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
1426   // int (C++ 4.5p1).
1427   if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
1428       !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
1429     if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
1430         (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
1431          // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
1432          // less than int to an int.
1433          (!FromType->isSignedIntegerType() &&
1434           Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType)))) {
1435       return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1436     }
1437 
1438     return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1439   }
1440 
1441   // C++0x [conv.prom]p3:
1442   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
1443   //   fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
1444   //   following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
1445   //   (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
1446   //   unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
1447   //   long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
1448   //   values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
1449   //   type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
1450   //   with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
1451   //   long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
1452   //   there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
1453   if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
1454     // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
1455     // provided for a scoped enumeration.
1456     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
1457       return false;
1458 
1459     // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
1460     if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
1461         !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromType, PDiag()))
1462       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType,
1463                                 FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
1464   }
1465 
1466   // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
1467   //   A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
1468   //   to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
1469   //   represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
1470   //   long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
1471   //   If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
1472   //   underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
1473   //   or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
1474   //   type.
1475   if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
1476       ToType->isIntegerType()) {
1477     // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
1478     // unsigned.
1479     bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
1480     uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
1481 
1482     // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
1483     // order. Try each of these types.
1484     QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
1485       Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
1486       Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
1487       Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
1488     };
1489     for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
1490       uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1491       if (FromSize < ToSize ||
1492           (FromSize == ToSize &&
1493            FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
1494         // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
1495         // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
1496         // promotion.
1497         return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
1498       }
1499     }
1500   }
1501 
1502   // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
1503   // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
1504   // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
1505   // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
1506   // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
1507   // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
1508   // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
1509   // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
1510   // conversion.
1511   using llvm::APSInt;
1512   if (From)
1513     if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getBitField()) {
1514       APSInt BitWidth;
1515       if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
1516           MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->isIntegerConstantExpr(BitWidth, Context)) {
1517         APSInt ToSize(BitWidth.getBitWidth(), BitWidth.isUnsigned());
1518         ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
1519 
1520         // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
1521         if (BitWidth < ToSize ||
1522             (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
1523           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
1524         }
1525 
1526         // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
1527         // that fits into an unsigned int?
1528         if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && BitWidth <= ToSize) {
1529           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
1530         }
1531 
1532         return false;
1533       }
1534     }
1535 
1536   // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
1537   // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
1538   if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
1539     return true;
1540   }
1541 
1542   return false;
1543 }
1544 
1545 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
1546 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
1547 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
1548 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
1549   if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
1550     if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
1551       /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
1552       /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
1553       if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
1554           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
1555         return true;
1556 
1557       // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
1558       //   When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
1559       //   double is promoted to long double [...].
1560       if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1561           (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
1562            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
1563           (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble))
1564         return true;
1565 
1566       // Half can be promoted to float.
1567       if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
1568           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
1569         return true;
1570     }
1571 
1572   return false;
1573 }
1574 
1575 /// \brief Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
1576 ///
1577 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
1578 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
1579 /// floating-point or integral promotion.
1580 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
1581   const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
1582   if (!FromComplex)
1583     return false;
1584 
1585   const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
1586   if (!ToComplex)
1587     return false;
1588 
1589   return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
1590                                   ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
1591     IsIntegralPromotion(0, FromComplex->getElementType(),
1592                         ToComplex->getElementType());
1593 }
1594 
1595 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
1596 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
1597 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
1598 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
1599 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
1600 ///
1601 static QualType
1602 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
1603                                    QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
1604                                    ASTContext &Context,
1605                                    bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
1606   assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
1607           FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
1608          "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
1609 
1610   /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
1611   if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
1612     return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1613 
1614   QualType CanonFromPointee
1615     = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
1616   QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
1617   Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
1618 
1619   if (StripObjCLifetime)
1620     Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
1621 
1622   // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
1623   if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
1624     // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
1625     if (!ToType.isNull())
1626       return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1627 
1628     // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
1629     // already.
1630     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1631       return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
1632     return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
1633   }
1634 
1635   // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
1636   QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
1637     = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
1638 
1639   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
1640     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1641   return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
1642 }
1643 
1644 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
1645                                                bool InOverloadResolution,
1646                                                ASTContext &Context) {
1647   // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
1648   // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
1649   if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
1650       Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
1651     return !InOverloadResolution;
1652 
1653   return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
1654                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
1655                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
1656 }
1657 
1658 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
1659 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
1660 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
1661 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
1662 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
1663 /// ConvertedType.
1664 ///
1665 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
1666 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
1667 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
1668 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
1669 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
1670 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
1671 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
1672 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
1673 /// should result in a warning.
1674 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1675                                bool InOverloadResolution,
1676                                QualType& ConvertedType,
1677                                bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1678   IncompatibleObjC = false;
1679   if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
1680                               IncompatibleObjC))
1681     return true;
1682 
1683   // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
1684   if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
1685       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
1686     ConvertedType = ToType;
1687     return true;
1688   }
1689 
1690   // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
1691   if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
1692       ToType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
1693     ConvertedType = ToType;
1694     return true;
1695   }
1696   // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
1697   // pointer type.
1698   if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
1699       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
1700     ConvertedType = ToType;
1701     return true;
1702   }
1703 
1704   // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
1705   // pointer constant.
1706   if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
1707       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
1708     ConvertedType = ToType;
1709     return true;
1710   }
1711 
1712   const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
1713   if (!ToTypePtr)
1714     return false;
1715 
1716   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
1717   if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
1718     ConvertedType = ToType;
1719     return true;
1720   }
1721 
1722   // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
1723   // , including objective-c pointers.
1724   QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
1725   if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
1726       !getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
1727     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
1728                                       FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
1729                                                        ToPointeeType,
1730                                                        ToType, Context);
1731     return true;
1732   }
1733   const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
1734   if (!FromTypePtr)
1735     return false;
1736 
1737   QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
1738 
1739   // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
1740   // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
1741   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
1742     return false;
1743 
1744   // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
1745   // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
1746   // 4.10p2).
1747   if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
1748       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
1749     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1750                                                        ToPointeeType,
1751                                                        ToType, Context,
1752                                                    /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
1753     return true;
1754   }
1755 
1756   // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
1757   if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
1758       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
1759     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1760                                                        ToPointeeType,
1761                                                        ToType, Context);
1762     return true;
1763   }
1764 
1765   // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
1766   // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
1767   if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1768       Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1769     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1770                                                        ToPointeeType,
1771                                                        ToType, Context);
1772     return true;
1773   }
1774 
1775   // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
1776   //
1777   //   An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
1778   //   can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
1779   //   B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
1780   //   (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
1781   //   necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
1782   //   conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
1783   //   derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
1784   //   the null pointer value of the destination type.
1785   //
1786   // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
1787   // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
1788   if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1789       FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
1790       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
1791       !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), FromPointeeType, PDiag()) &&
1792       IsDerivedFrom(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1793     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1794                                                        ToPointeeType,
1795                                                        ToType, Context);
1796     return true;
1797   }
1798 
1799   if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
1800       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
1801     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
1802                                                        ToPointeeType,
1803                                                        ToType, Context);
1804     return true;
1805   }
1806 
1807   return false;
1808 }
1809 
1810 /// \brief Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
1811 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
1812   Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
1813 
1814   // Check whether qualifiers already match.
1815   if (TQs == Qs)
1816     return T;
1817 
1818   if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
1819     return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
1820 
1821   return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
1822 }
1823 
1824 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
1825 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
1826 /// with the same arguments and return values.
1827 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1828                                    QualType& ConvertedType,
1829                                    bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
1830   if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
1831     return false;
1832 
1833   // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
1834   Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
1835 
1836   // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
1837   const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
1838     ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
1839   const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
1840     FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
1841 
1842   if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
1843     // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
1844     // then this is not a pointer conversion.
1845     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1846                                        FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1847       return false;
1848 
1849     // Check for compatible
1850     // Objective C++: We're able to convert between "id" or "Class" and a
1851     // pointer to any interface (in both directions).
1852     if (ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType() && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1853       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
1854       return true;
1855     }
1856     // Conversions with Objective-C's id<...>.
1857     if ((FromObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
1858          ToObjCPtr->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
1859         Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType,
1860                                                   /*compare=*/false)) {
1861       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
1862       return true;
1863     }
1864     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to an
1865     // interface to a pointer to a different interface.
1866     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
1867       const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1868       const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
1869       if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
1870           !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
1871                                                 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
1872         return false;
1873       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
1874                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1875                                                          ToType, Context);
1876       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
1877       return true;
1878     }
1879 
1880     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
1881       // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
1882       // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
1883       // complain about it.
1884       IncompatibleObjC = true;
1885       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
1886                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
1887                                                          ToType, Context);
1888       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
1889       return true;
1890     }
1891   }
1892   // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
1893   QualType ToPointeeType;
1894   if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
1895     ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
1896   else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
1897             ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
1898     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
1899     // to a block pointer type.
1900     if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1901       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
1902       return true;
1903     }
1904     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1905   }
1906   else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
1907            ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
1908     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
1909     // pointer to any object.
1910     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
1911     return true;
1912   }
1913   else
1914     return false;
1915 
1916   QualType FromPointeeType;
1917   if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
1918     FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
1919   else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
1920            FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
1921     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
1922   else
1923     return false;
1924 
1925   // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
1926   // is an Objective-C conversion.
1927   if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
1928       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1929                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
1930     // We always complain about this conversion.
1931     IncompatibleObjC = true;
1932     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
1933     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
1934     return true;
1935   }
1936   // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
1937   // as in I* to id.
1938   if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1939       ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
1940       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
1941                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
1942 
1943     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
1944     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
1945     return true;
1946   }
1947 
1948   // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
1949   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
1950   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
1951   // complain about it).
1952   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
1953     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
1954   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
1955     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
1956   if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
1957     // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
1958     // Objective-C pointer conversion.
1959     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
1960           == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
1961       return false;
1962 
1963     // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
1964     // function types are obviously different.
1965     if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
1966         FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
1967         FromFunctionType->getTypeQuals() != ToFunctionType->getTypeQuals())
1968       return false;
1969 
1970     bool HasObjCConversion = false;
1971     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getResultType())
1972           == Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
1973       // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1974     } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
1975                                        ToFunctionType->getResultType(),
1976                                        ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1977       // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1978       HasObjCConversion = true;
1979     } else {
1980       // Function types are too different. Abort.
1981       return false;
1982     }
1983 
1984     // Check argument types.
1985     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
1986          ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
1987       QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1988       QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
1989       if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
1990             == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
1991         // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
1992       } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
1993                                          ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1994         // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
1995         HasObjCConversion = true;
1996       } else {
1997         // Argument types are too different. Abort.
1998         return false;
1999       }
2000     }
2001 
2002     if (HasObjCConversion) {
2003       // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2004       // conversion, but complain about it.
2005       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2006       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2007       return true;
2008     }
2009   }
2010 
2011   return false;
2012 }
2013 
2014 /// \brief Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2015 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2016 ///
2017 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2018 ///
2019 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2020 ///
2021 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2022 /// this conversion.
2023 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2024                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2025   if (!getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2026       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2027     return false;
2028 
2029   // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2030   QualType ToPointee;
2031   if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2032     ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2033   else
2034     return false;
2035 
2036   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2037   if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2038       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
2039       !ToQuals.withoutObjCGLifetime().empty())
2040     return false;
2041 
2042   // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2043   QualType FromPointee;
2044   if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2045     FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2046   else
2047     return false;
2048 
2049   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2050   if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2051       (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2052        FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2053     return false;
2054 
2055   // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2056   FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2057   if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2058     return false;
2059 
2060   // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2061   // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2062   // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2063   FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2064 
2065   // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2066   ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2067   bool IncompatibleObjC;
2068   if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2069     FromPointee = ToPointee;
2070   else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2071                                     IncompatibleObjC))
2072     return false;
2073 
2074   /// \brief Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2075   /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2076   FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2077   ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2078   return true;
2079 }
2080 
2081 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2082                                     QualType& ConvertedType) {
2083   QualType ToPointeeType;
2084   if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2085         ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2086     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2087   else
2088     return false;
2089 
2090   QualType FromPointeeType;
2091   if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2092       FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2093     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2094   else
2095     return false;
2096   // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2097   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2098   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2099 
2100   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2101     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2102   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2103     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2104 
2105   if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2106     return false;
2107 
2108   if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2109     return true;
2110 
2111   // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2112   // function types are obviously different.
2113   if (FromFunctionType->getNumArgs() != ToFunctionType->getNumArgs() ||
2114       FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2115     return false;
2116 
2117   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2118   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2119   if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2120     return false;
2121 
2122   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
2123   if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getResultType(),
2124                           ToFunctionType->getResultType())) {
2125     // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2126   } else {
2127     QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getResultType();
2128     QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getResultType();
2129     if ((!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2130         !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2131        LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2132 
2133      if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2134        // OK exact match.
2135      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2136                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2137      if (IncompatibleObjC)
2138        return false;
2139      // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2140      }
2141      else
2142        return false;
2143    }
2144 
2145    // Check argument types.
2146    for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumArgs();
2147         ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2148      IncompatibleObjC = false;
2149      QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2150      QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getArgType(ArgIdx);
2151      if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2152        // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2153      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2154                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2155        if (IncompatibleObjC)
2156          return false;
2157        // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2158      } else
2159        // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2160        return false;
2161    }
2162    if (LangOpts.ObjCAutoRefCount &&
2163        !Context.FunctionTypesMatchOnNSConsumedAttrs(FromFunctionType,
2164                                                     ToFunctionType))
2165      return false;
2166 
2167    ConvertedType = ToType;
2168    return true;
2169 }
2170 
2171 /// FunctionArgTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
2172 /// for equlity of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
2173 /// they have same number of arguments. This routine assumes that Objective-C
2174 /// pointer types which only differ in their protocol qualifiers are equal.
2175 bool Sema::FunctionArgTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
2176                                     const FunctionProtoType *NewType) {
2177   if (!getLangOptions().ObjC1)
2178     return std::equal(OldType->arg_type_begin(), OldType->arg_type_end(),
2179                       NewType->arg_type_begin());
2180 
2181   for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator O = OldType->arg_type_begin(),
2182        N = NewType->arg_type_begin(),
2183        E = OldType->arg_type_end(); O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2184     QualType ToType = (*O);
2185     QualType FromType = (*N);
2186     if (ToType != FromType) {
2187       if (const PointerType *PTTo = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2188         if (const PointerType *PTFr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2189           if ((PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType() &&
2190                PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) ||
2191               (PTTo->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType() &&
2192                PTFr->getPointeeType()->isObjCQualifiedClassType()))
2193             continue;
2194       }
2195       else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTTo =
2196                  ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2197         if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTFr =
2198               FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
2199           if (PTTo->getInterfaceDecl() == PTFr->getInterfaceDecl())
2200             continue;
2201       }
2202       return false;
2203     }
2204   }
2205   return true;
2206 }
2207 
2208 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2209 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
2210 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
2211 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2212 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2213 /// error, or returns false otherwise.
2214 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2215                                   CastKind &Kind,
2216                                   CXXCastPath& BasePath,
2217                                   bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
2218   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2219   bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
2220 
2221   Kind = CK_BitCast;
2222 
2223   if (!IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
2224       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy) &&
2225       From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
2226     DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
2227                         PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
2228                           << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
2229 
2230   if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2231     if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
2232       QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
2233                ToPointeeType   = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
2234 
2235       if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2236           !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2237         // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
2238         // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
2239         if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType,
2240                                          From->getExprLoc(),
2241                                          From->getSourceRange(), &BasePath,
2242                                          IgnoreBaseAccess))
2243           return true;
2244 
2245         // The conversion was successful.
2246         Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
2247       }
2248     }
2249   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
2250                ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2251     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
2252           FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
2253       // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
2254       // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
2255       // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
2256       if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
2257         return false;
2258     } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2259       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2260     } else {
2261       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
2262     }
2263   } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
2264     if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
2265       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
2266   }
2267 
2268   // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
2269   // reasons.
2270   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
2271     Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
2272 
2273   return false;
2274 }
2275 
2276 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2277 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
2278 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
2279 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
2280 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
2281 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
2282                                      QualType ToType,
2283                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
2284                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2285   const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2286   if (!ToTypePtr)
2287     return false;
2288 
2289   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
2290   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2291                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2292                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
2293     ConvertedType = ToType;
2294     return true;
2295   }
2296 
2297   // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
2298   const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2299   if (!FromTypePtr)
2300     return false;
2301 
2302   // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
2303   // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
2304   QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2305   QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
2306 
2307   if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
2308       !RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToClass, PDiag()) &&
2309       IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass)) {
2310     ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
2311                                                  ToClass.getTypePtr());
2312     return true;
2313   }
2314 
2315   return false;
2316 }
2317 
2318 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
2319 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
2320 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
2321 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
2322 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
2323 /// otherwise.
2324 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2325                                         CastKind &Kind,
2326                                         CXXCastPath &BasePath,
2327                                         bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
2328   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2329   const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2330   if (!FromPtrType) {
2331     // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
2332     assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2333                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
2334            "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
2335     Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
2336     return false;
2337   }
2338 
2339   const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
2340   assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
2341                       "that is not a member pointer.");
2342 
2343   QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2344   QualType ToClass   = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
2345 
2346   // FIXME: What about dependent types?
2347   assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2348   assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
2349 
2350   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
2351                      /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
2352   bool DerivationOkay = IsDerivedFrom(ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
2353   assert(DerivationOkay &&
2354          "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
2355   (void)DerivationOkay;
2356 
2357   if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
2358                                   getUnqualifiedType())) {
2359     std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
2360     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
2361       << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
2362     return true;
2363   }
2364 
2365   if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
2366     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
2367       << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
2368       << From->getSourceRange();
2369     return true;
2370   }
2371 
2372   if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
2373     CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
2374                          Paths.front(),
2375                          diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
2376 
2377   // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
2378   BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
2379   Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
2380   return false;
2381 }
2382 
2383 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
2384 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
2385 /// (C++ 4.4).
2386 ///
2387 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
2388 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
2389 /// object lifetime.
2390 bool
2391 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2392                                 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
2393   FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
2394   ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
2395   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
2396 
2397   // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
2398   // qualification conversion.
2399   if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
2400     return false;
2401 
2402   // (C++ 4.4p4):
2403   //   A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
2404   //   in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
2405   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
2406   bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
2407   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
2408     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
2409     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
2410     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
2411     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
2412     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left to
2413     // unwrap.
2414     UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
2415 
2416     Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
2417     Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
2418 
2419     // Objective-C ARC:
2420     //   Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
2421     if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() &&
2422         UnwrappedAnyPointer) {
2423       if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
2424         ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
2425         FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2426         ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
2427       } else {
2428         // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
2429         // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
2430         return false;
2431       }
2432     }
2433 
2434     // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
2435     if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
2436         (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
2437       FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2438       ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2439     }
2440 
2441     //   -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
2442     //      2,j, and similarly for volatile.
2443     if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2444       return false;
2445 
2446     //   -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
2447     //      every cv for 0 < k < j.
2448     if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers()
2449         && !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
2450       return false;
2451 
2452     // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
2453     // include const.
2454     PreviousToQualsIncludeConst
2455       = PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
2456   }
2457 
2458   // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
2459   // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
2460   // of types. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
2461   // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
2462   // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
2463   return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
2464 }
2465 
2466 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
2467 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
2468 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
2469 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
2470 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
2471 /// false and User is unspecified.
2472 ///
2473 /// \param AllowExplicit  true if the conversion should consider C++0x
2474 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
2475 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
2476 static OverloadingResult
2477 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2478                         UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
2479                         OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
2480                         bool AllowExplicit) {
2481   // Whether we will only visit constructors.
2482   bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
2483 
2484   // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
2485   // constructors.
2486   if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
2487     // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
2488     //   When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
2489     //   copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
2490     //   derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
2491     //   constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
2492     //   functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
2493     //   that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
2494     //   the parentheses of the initializer.
2495     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
2496         (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
2497          S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getType(), ToType)))
2498       ConstructorsOnly = true;
2499 
2500     S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ToType, S.PDiag());
2501     // RequireCompleteType may have returned true due to some invalid decl
2502     // during template instantiation, but ToType may be complete enough now
2503     // to try to recover.
2504     if (ToType->isIncompleteType()) {
2505       // We're not going to find any constructors.
2506     } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
2507                  = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
2508       DeclContext::lookup_iterator Con, ConEnd;
2509       for (llvm::tie(Con, ConEnd) = S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl);
2510            Con != ConEnd; ++Con) {
2511         NamedDecl *D = *Con;
2512         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(D, D->getAccess());
2513 
2514         // Find the constructor (which may be a template).
2515         CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = 0;
2516         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConstructorTmpl
2517           = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
2518         if (ConstructorTmpl)
2519           Constructor
2520             = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ConstructorTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
2521         else
2522           Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D);
2523 
2524         if (!Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
2525             Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(AllowExplicit)) {
2526           if (ConstructorTmpl)
2527             S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(ConstructorTmpl, FoundDecl,
2528                                            /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
2529                                            &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2530                                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2531                                              !ConstructorsOnly);
2532           else
2533             // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
2534             // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
2535             S.AddOverloadCandidate(Constructor, FoundDecl,
2536                                    &From, 1, CandidateSet,
2537                                    /*SuppressUserConversions=*/
2538                                      !ConstructorsOnly);
2539         }
2540       }
2541     }
2542   }
2543 
2544   // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
2545   if (ConstructorsOnly) {
2546   } else if (S.RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), From->getType(),
2547                                    S.PDiag(0) << From->getSourceRange())) {
2548     // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
2549   } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType
2550                                    = From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
2551     if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
2552          = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
2553       // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
2554       const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
2555         = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
2556       for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
2557              E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
2558         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
2559         NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
2560         CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
2561         if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2562           D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2563 
2564         CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
2565         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
2566         if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
2567           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
2568         else
2569           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
2570 
2571         if (AllowExplicit || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
2572           if (ConvTemplate)
2573             S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, FoundDecl,
2574                                              ActingContext, From, ToType,
2575                                              CandidateSet);
2576           else
2577             S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
2578                                      From, ToType, CandidateSet);
2579         }
2580       }
2581     }
2582   }
2583 
2584   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
2585 
2586   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
2587   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getLocStart(), Best, true)) {
2588   case OR_Success:
2589     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
2590     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
2591           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
2592       S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Constructor);
2593 
2594       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2595       //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2596       //   constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
2597       //   sequence converts the source type to the type required by
2598       //   the argument of the constructor.
2599       //
2600       QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType(S.Context);
2601       if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
2602         User.EllipsisConversion = true;
2603       else {
2604         User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2605         User.EllipsisConversion = false;
2606       }
2607       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2608       User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
2609       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2610       User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
2611       User.After.setFromType(ThisType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
2612       User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
2613       return OR_Success;
2614     } else if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
2615                  = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
2616       S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(From->getLocStart(), Conversion);
2617 
2618       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
2619       //
2620       //   [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
2621       //   conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
2622       //   conversion sequence converts the source type to the
2623       //   implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
2624       User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
2625       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
2626       User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
2627       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
2628       User.EllipsisConversion = false;
2629 
2630       // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
2631       //   The second standard conversion sequence converts the
2632       //   result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
2633       //   for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
2634       //   is an initialization, the special rules for
2635       //   initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
2636       //   selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
2637       //   user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
2638       //   13.3.3.1).
2639       User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
2640       return OR_Success;
2641     } else {
2642       llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
2643       return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2644     }
2645 
2646   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
2647     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2648   case OR_Deleted:
2649     // No conversion here! We're done.
2650     return OR_Deleted;
2651 
2652   case OR_Ambiguous:
2653     return OR_Ambiguous;
2654   }
2655 
2656   return OR_No_Viable_Function;
2657 }
2658 
2659 bool
2660 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
2661   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
2662   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc());
2663   OverloadingResult OvResult =
2664     IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
2665                             CandidateSet, false);
2666   if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
2667     Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2668          diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
2669           << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2670   else if (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())
2671     Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
2672          diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
2673     << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
2674   else
2675     return false;
2676   CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &From, 1);
2677   return true;
2678 }
2679 
2680 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
2681 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2682 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
2683 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2684 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2685                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
2686                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
2687 {
2688   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
2689   // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
2690   //   -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
2691   //      conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
2692   //      an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
2693   //   -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
2694   //      conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
2695   //      (13.3.3.1.3).
2696   //
2697   // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
2698   //   For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
2699   //   described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
2700   //   treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
2701   //   from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
2702   if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
2703     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2704   else if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
2705     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2706 
2707   // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
2708   // the same kind.
2709   if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
2710     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2711 
2712   // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
2713   // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
2714   // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2715   if (ICS1.isStandard())
2716     return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
2717   else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
2718     // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
2719     // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
2720     // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
2721     // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
2722     // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
2723     // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
2724     if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
2725           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
2726       return CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
2727                                                 ICS1.UserDefined.After,
2728                                                 ICS2.UserDefined.After);
2729   }
2730 
2731   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2732 }
2733 
2734 static bool hasSimilarType(ASTContext &Context, QualType T1, QualType T2) {
2735   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
2736     Qualifiers Quals;
2737     T1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, Quals);
2738     T2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, Quals);
2739   }
2740 
2741   return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2);
2742 }
2743 
2744 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
2745 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
2746 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2747 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
2748                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2749                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2750   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
2751     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2752 
2753   // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
2754   // any non-identity conversion sequence
2755   if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2756     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2757   else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
2758     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2759 
2760   if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
2761     if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
2762       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2763     else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
2764       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2765     else
2766       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2767   } else if (!hasSimilarType(Context, SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
2768     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2769 
2770   if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
2771     return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
2772                              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2773   }
2774 
2775   if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
2776     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2777              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2778              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2779 
2780   if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
2781     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2782              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
2783              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2784 
2785   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2786 }
2787 
2788 /// \brief Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
2789 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
2790 static bool isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
2791                                        const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
2792   // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2793   //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
2794   //      implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
2795   //      without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
2796   //      to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
2797   //      lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
2798   //      reference*.
2799   //
2800   // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
2801   // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
2802   // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
2803   // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
2804   // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
2805   if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
2806       SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
2807     return false;
2808 
2809   return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
2810           SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
2811          (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
2812           !SCS2.IsLvalueReference);
2813 }
2814 
2815 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
2816 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
2817 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
2818 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2819 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S,
2820                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2821                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
2822 {
2823   // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
2824   // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
2825 
2826   //  -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
2827   //     sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
2828   //     excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
2829   //     sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
2830   //     non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
2831   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
2832         = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
2833     return CK;
2834 
2835   //  -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
2836   //     defined below), or, if not that,
2837   ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
2838   ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
2839   if (Rank1 < Rank2)
2840     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2841   else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
2842     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2843 
2844   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
2845   // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
2846   // applies:
2847 
2848   //   A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
2849   //   pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
2850   //   that is such a conversion.
2851   if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
2852     return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
2853              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2854              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2855 
2856   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
2857   //
2858   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
2859   //   conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
2860   //   void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
2861   //   of B* to void*.
2862   bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
2863     = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
2864   bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
2865     = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
2866   if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2867     // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
2868     // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
2869     return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2870                               : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2871   } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
2872     // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
2873     // their derived-to-base conversions.
2874     if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
2875           = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
2876       return DerivedCK;
2877   } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
2878              !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
2879     // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
2880     // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
2881     // inheritance relationship in their sources.
2882     QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
2883     QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
2884 
2885     // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
2886     // conversion, if we need to.
2887     if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
2888       FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
2889     if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
2890       FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
2891 
2892     QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2893     QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
2894 
2895     if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
2896       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2897     else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
2898       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2899 
2900     // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
2901     // other, it is the better one.
2902     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
2903       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2904     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
2905       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2906     if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
2907       bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
2908                                                           FromObjCPtr2);
2909       bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
2910                                                            FromObjCPtr1);
2911       if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
2912         return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
2913                          : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2914       }
2915     }
2916   }
2917 
2918   // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
2919   // bullet 3).
2920   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
2921         = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
2922     return QualCK;
2923 
2924   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
2925     // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
2926     if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
2927       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2928     else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
2929       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2930 
2931     // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
2932     //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
2933     //      which the references refer are the same type except for
2934     //      top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
2935     //      initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
2936     //      to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
2937     QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
2938     QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
2939     T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
2940     T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
2941     Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
2942     QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
2943     QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
2944     if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
2945       // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
2946       // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
2947       if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
2948                                           SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
2949         return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
2950                                            ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
2951                                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2952       }
2953 
2954       // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
2955       // type for comparison.
2956       if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
2957         T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
2958       if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
2959         T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
2960       if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
2961         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2962       else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
2963         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
2964     }
2965   }
2966 
2967   // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
2968   // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
2969   // is between types of the same size.
2970   // For example:
2971   // void f(float);
2972   // void f(int);
2973   // int main {
2974   //    long a;
2975   //    f(a);
2976   // }
2977   // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
2978   // as clang will do in standard mode.
2979   if (S.getLangOptions().MicrosoftMode &&
2980       SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
2981       SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
2982       S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
2983       S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
2984     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
2985 
2986   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
2987 }
2988 
2989 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
2990 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
2991 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
2992 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
2993 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
2994                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
2995                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
2996   // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
2997   //  -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
2998   //     yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
2999   //     cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
3000   //     the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
3001   //     deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
3002   if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
3003       SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
3004     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3005 
3006   // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
3007   // conversion (!)
3008   QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
3009   QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
3010   T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
3011   T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
3012   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3013   QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3014   QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3015 
3016   // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapped
3017   // them.
3018   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
3019     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3020 
3021   // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3022   // for comparison.
3023   if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3024     T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3025   if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3026     T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3027 
3028   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3029     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3030 
3031   // Objective-C++ ARC:
3032   //   Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
3033   //   to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
3034   if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
3035                                       SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
3036     Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3037                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3038                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3039   }
3040 
3041   while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarPointerTypes(T1, T2)) {
3042     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
3043     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
3044     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
3045     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
3046     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
3047     // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
3048     // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
3049     // strict subset of qualifiers.
3050     if (T1.getCVRQualifiers() == T2.getCVRQualifiers())
3051       // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
3052       // about how the sequences rank.
3053       ;
3054     else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
3055       // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3056       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
3057         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3058         // qualifiers.
3059         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3060 
3061       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3062     } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
3063       // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
3064       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
3065         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
3066         // qualifiers.
3067         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3068 
3069       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3070     } else {
3071       // Qualifiers are disjoint.
3072       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3073     }
3074 
3075     // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
3076     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
3077       break;
3078   }
3079 
3080   // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
3081   // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
3082   switch (Result) {
3083   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
3084     if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
3085       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3086     break;
3087 
3088   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
3089     break;
3090 
3091   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
3092     if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
3093       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3094     break;
3095   }
3096 
3097   return Result;
3098 }
3099 
3100 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
3101 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
3102 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
3103 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3).  As part of these checks, we also look at
3104 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
3105 ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3106 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S,
3107                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3108                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3109   QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
3110   QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
3111   QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
3112   QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
3113 
3114   // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
3115   // conversion, if we need to.
3116   if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3117     FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
3118   if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
3119     FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
3120 
3121   // Canonicalize all of the types.
3122   FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
3123   ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
3124   FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
3125   ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
3126 
3127   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
3128   //
3129   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
3130   //   class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
3131   //
3132   // Compare based on pointer conversions.
3133   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3134       SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3135       /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
3136       FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
3137       ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
3138     QualType FromPointee1
3139       = FromType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3140     QualType ToPointee1
3141       = ToType1->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3142     QualType FromPointee2
3143       = FromType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3144     QualType ToPointee2
3145       = ToType2->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
3146 
3147     //   -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3148     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
3149       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
3150         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3151       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
3152         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3153     }
3154 
3155     //   -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
3156     if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
3157       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
3158         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3159       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
3160         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3161     }
3162   } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
3163              SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
3164     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
3165       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3166     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
3167       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3168     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
3169       = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3170     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
3171       = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
3172 
3173     if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
3174       // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
3175       // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
3176       // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
3177       // Objective-C pointer types.
3178       bool FromAssignLeft
3179         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
3180       bool FromAssignRight
3181         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
3182       bool ToAssignLeft
3183         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
3184       bool ToAssignRight
3185         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
3186 
3187       // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
3188       // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
3189       if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
3190           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3191         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3192       if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
3193           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3194         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3195 
3196       // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
3197       // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
3198       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3199         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3200       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3201         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3202 
3203       // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
3204       // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
3205       if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3206           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
3207         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3208       if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
3209           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
3210         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3211 
3212       // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
3213       // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
3214       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
3215         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3216       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
3217         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3218 
3219       //   -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3220       if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3221           !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
3222           (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight))
3223         return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3224                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3225 
3226       //   -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
3227       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
3228           (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
3229         return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3230         : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3231     }
3232   }
3233 
3234   // Ranking of member-pointer types.
3235   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
3236       FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
3237       ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
3238     const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer1 =
3239                                         FromType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3240     const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer1 =
3241                                           ToType1->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3242     const MemberPointerType * FromMemPointer2 =
3243                                           FromType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3244     const MemberPointerType * ToMemPointer2 =
3245                                           ToType2->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3246     const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
3247     const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
3248     const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
3249     const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
3250     QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3251     QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3252     QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3253     QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
3254     // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
3255     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
3256       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
3257         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3258       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
3259         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3260     }
3261     // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
3262     if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
3263       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
3264         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3265       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
3266         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3267     }
3268   }
3269 
3270   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
3271     //   -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
3272     //   -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
3273     //      B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3274     //      reference of type A&,
3275     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3276         !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3277       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType1, ToType2))
3278         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3279       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(ToType2, ToType1))
3280         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3281     }
3282 
3283     //   -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
3284     //   -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
3285     //      A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
3286     //      reference of type A&,
3287     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
3288         S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
3289       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType2, FromType1))
3290         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3291       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType1, FromType2))
3292         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3293     }
3294   }
3295 
3296   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3297 }
3298 
3299 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
3300 /// determine whether they are reference-related,
3301 /// reference-compatible, reference-compatible with added
3302 /// qualification, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
3303 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
3304 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
3305 /// type being initialized.
3306 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
3307 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
3308                                    QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
3309                                    bool &DerivedToBase,
3310                                    bool &ObjCConversion,
3311                                    bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3312   assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
3313     "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
3314   assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
3315 
3316   QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
3317   QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
3318   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
3319   QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
3320   QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
3321 
3322   // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3323   //   Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
3324   //   reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is the same type as T2, or
3325   //   T1 is a base class of T2.
3326   DerivedToBase = false;
3327   ObjCConversion = false;
3328   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
3329   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
3330     // Nothing to do.
3331   } else if (!RequireCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2, PDiag()) &&
3332            IsDerivedFrom(UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
3333     DerivedToBase = true;
3334   else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3335            UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
3336            Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
3337     ObjCConversion = true;
3338   else
3339     return Ref_Incompatible;
3340 
3341   // At this point, we know that T1 and T2 are reference-related (at
3342   // least).
3343 
3344   // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the type
3345   // for comparison.
3346   if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
3347     T1 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
3348   if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
3349     T2 = Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
3350 
3351   // C++ [dcl.init.ref]p4:
3352   //   "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if T1 is
3353   //   reference-related to T2 and cv1 is the same cv-qualification
3354   //   as, or greater cv-qualification than, cv2. For purposes of
3355   //   overload resolution, cases for which cv1 is greater
3356   //   cv-qualification than cv2 are identified as
3357   //   reference-compatible with added qualification (see 13.3.3.2).
3358   //
3359   // Note that we also require equivalence of Objective-C GC and address-space
3360   // qualifiers when performing these computations, so that e.g., an int in
3361   // address space 1 is not reference-compatible with an int in address
3362   // space 2.
3363   if (T1Quals.getObjCLifetime() != T2Quals.getObjCLifetime() &&
3364       T1Quals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(T2Quals)) {
3365     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3366     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3367     ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3368   }
3369 
3370   if (T1Quals == T2Quals)
3371     return Ref_Compatible;
3372   else if (T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
3373     return Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification;
3374   else
3375     return Ref_Related;
3376 }
3377 
3378 /// \brief Look for a user-defined conversion to an value reference-compatible
3379 ///        with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
3380 static bool
3381 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
3382                          QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3383                          Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
3384                          bool AllowExplicit) {
3385   assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
3386   CXXRecordDecl *T2RecordDecl
3387     = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
3388 
3389   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(DeclLoc);
3390   const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
3391     = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3392   for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
3393          E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
3394     NamedDecl *D = *I;
3395     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3396     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3397       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3398 
3399     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
3400       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
3401     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3402     if (ConvTemplate)
3403       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3404     else
3405       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3406 
3407     // If this is an explicit conversion, and we're not allowed to consider
3408     // explicit conversions, skip it.
3409     if (!AllowExplicit && Conv->isExplicit())
3410       continue;
3411 
3412     if (AllowRvalues) {
3413       bool DerivedToBase = false;
3414       bool ObjCConversion = false;
3415       bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
3416 
3417       // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
3418       // functions that return lvalues.
3419       if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
3420         const ReferenceType *RefType
3421           = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
3422         if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
3423           continue;
3424       }
3425 
3426       if (!ConvTemplate &&
3427           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
3428             DeclLoc,
3429             Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
3430               .getUnqualifiedType(),
3431             DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType(),
3432             DerivedToBase, ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion) ==
3433           Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
3434         continue;
3435     } else {
3436       // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
3437       // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
3438       // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
3439 
3440       const ReferenceType *RefType =
3441         Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
3442       if (!RefType ||
3443           (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
3444            !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
3445         continue;
3446     }
3447 
3448     if (ConvTemplate)
3449       S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC,
3450                                        Init, DeclType, CandidateSet);
3451     else
3452       S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init,
3453                                DeclType, CandidateSet);
3454   }
3455 
3456   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3457 
3458   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3459   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best, true)) {
3460   case OR_Success:
3461     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3462     //
3463     //   [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
3464     //   applying a conversion function to the argument
3465     //   expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
3466     //   user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
3467     //   second standard conversion sequence either an identity
3468     //   conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
3469     //   entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
3470     //   type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
3471     if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
3472       return false;
3473 
3474     if (Best->Function)
3475       S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(DeclLoc, Best->Function);
3476     ICS.setUserDefined();
3477     ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3478     ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3479     ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3480     ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
3481     ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3482     ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
3483     assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
3484            ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
3485            "Expected a direct reference binding!");
3486     return true;
3487 
3488   case OR_Ambiguous:
3489     ICS.setAmbiguous();
3490     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
3491          Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
3492       if (Cand->Viable)
3493         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->Function);
3494     return true;
3495 
3496   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3497   case OR_Deleted:
3498     // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
3499     // conversion; continue with other checks.
3500     return false;
3501   }
3502 
3503   return false;
3504 }
3505 
3506 /// \brief Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
3507 /// initialization.
3508 static ImplicitConversionSequence
3509 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *&Init, QualType DeclType,
3510                  SourceLocation DeclLoc,
3511                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
3512                  bool AllowExplicit) {
3513   assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
3514 
3515   // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
3516   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3517   ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3518 
3519   QualType T1 = DeclType->getAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
3520   QualType T2 = Init->getType();
3521 
3522   // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
3523   // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
3524   // type of the resulting function.
3525   if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
3526     DeclAccessPair Found;
3527     if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
3528                                                                 false, Found))
3529       T2 = Fn->getType();
3530   }
3531 
3532   // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
3533   bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
3534   bool DerivedToBase = false;
3535   bool ObjCConversion = false;
3536   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
3537   Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
3538   Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship
3539     = S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, DerivedToBase,
3540                                      ObjCConversion, ObjCLifetimeConversion);
3541 
3542 
3543   // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
3544   //   A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
3545   //   of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
3546 
3547   //     -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
3548   if (!isRValRef) {
3549     //     -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
3550     //        reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
3551     //
3552     // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
3553     if (InitCategory.isLValue() &&
3554         RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification) {
3555       // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
3556       //   When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
3557       //   to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
3558       //   is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
3559       //   has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
3560       //   in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
3561       //   derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
3562       ICS.setStandard();
3563       ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
3564       ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3565                          : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3566                          : ICK_Identity;
3567       ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3568       ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3569       ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3570       ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3571       ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3572       ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3573       ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
3574       ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3575       ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3576       ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = false;
3577       ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
3578       ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
3579       ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
3580 
3581       // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
3582       // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
3583       // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
3584       // [over.best.ics]p2).
3585       return ICS;
3586     }
3587 
3588     //       -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
3589     //          not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
3590     //          converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
3591     //          is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
3592     //          conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
3593     //          conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
3594     //          one through overload resolution (13.3)),
3595     if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
3596         !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
3597         RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
3598       if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3599                                    Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
3600                                    AllowExplicit))
3601         return ICS;
3602     }
3603   }
3604 
3605   //     -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
3606   //        non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
3607   //        shall be an rvalue reference.
3608   //
3609   // We actually handle one oddity of C++ [over.ics.ref] at this
3610   // point, which is that, due to p2 (which short-circuits reference
3611   // binding by only attempting a simple conversion for non-direct
3612   // bindings) and p3's strange wording, we allow a const volatile
3613   // reference to bind to an rvalue. Hence the check for the presence
3614   // of "const" rather than checking for "const" being the only
3615   // qualifier.
3616   // This is also the point where rvalue references and lvalue inits no longer
3617   // go together.
3618   if (!isRValRef && !T1.isConstQualified())
3619     return ICS;
3620 
3621   //       -- If the initializer expression
3622   //
3623   //            -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
3624   //               lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
3625   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Compatible_With_Added_Qualification &&
3626       (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
3627       (InitCategory.isPRValue() && (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
3628       (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
3629     ICS.setStandard();
3630     ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
3631     ICS.Standard.Second = DerivedToBase? ICK_Derived_To_Base
3632                       : ObjCConversion? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
3633                       : ICK_Identity;
3634     ICS.Standard.Third = ICK_Identity;
3635     ICS.Standard.FromTypePtr = T2.getAsOpaquePtr();
3636     ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
3637     ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
3638     ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
3639     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3640     // In C++0x, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
3641     // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
3642     // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
3643     // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
3644     // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
3645     ICS.Standard.DirectBinding =
3646       S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x ||
3647       (InitCategory.isPRValue() && !T2->isRecordType());
3648     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3649     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3650     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
3651     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
3652     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
3653     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = 0;
3654     return ICS;
3655   }
3656 
3657   //            -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
3658   //               reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
3659   //               an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
3660   //               "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
3661   //               "cv3 T3",
3662   //
3663   //          then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
3664   //          expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
3665   //          in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
3666   //          class subobject).
3667   if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3668       T2->isRecordType() && !S.RequireCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2, 0) &&
3669       FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
3670                                Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
3671                                AllowExplicit)) {
3672     // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
3673     // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
3674     // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
3675     // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
3676     if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
3677         ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
3678       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
3679 
3680     return ICS;
3681   }
3682 
3683   //       -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
3684   //          initialized from the initializer expression using the
3685   //          rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
3686   //          reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
3687   //          reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
3688   //          cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
3689   //          cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
3690   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
3691     // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
3692     // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
3693     // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
3694     // initialization fails.
3695     //
3696     // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
3697     // ObjC GC and lifetime qualifiers aren't important.
3698     Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
3699     Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
3700     T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3701     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3702     T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3703     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
3704     if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
3705       return ICS;
3706   }
3707 
3708   // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
3709   // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
3710   // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
3711   // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
3712   // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
3713   if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
3714       (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
3715     return ICS;
3716 
3717   // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
3718   // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
3719   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
3720       isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
3721     return ICS;
3722 
3723   // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
3724   //   When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
3725   //   an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
3726   //   required to convert the argument expression to the
3727   //   underlying type of the reference according to
3728   //   13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
3729   //   to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
3730   //   the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
3731   //   cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
3732   //   and does not constitute a conversion.
3733   ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
3734                               /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
3735                               /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
3736                               /*CStyle=*/false,
3737                               /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
3738 
3739   // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
3740   if (ICS.isStandard()) {
3741     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
3742     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3743     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3744     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
3745     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
3746     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
3747   } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
3748     // Don't allow rvalue references to bind to lvalues.
3749     if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
3750       if (const ReferenceType *RefType
3751             = ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getResultType()
3752                 ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
3753         if (!RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()) {
3754           ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init,
3755                      DeclType);
3756           return ICS;
3757         }
3758       }
3759     }
3760 
3761     ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
3762     ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
3763     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
3764     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = true;
3765     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
3766     ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
3767   }
3768 
3769   return ICS;
3770 }
3771 
3772 static ImplicitConversionSequence
3773 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3774                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
3775                       bool InOverloadResolution,
3776                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
3777 
3778 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
3779 /// initializer list From.
3780 static ImplicitConversionSequence
3781 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
3782                   bool SuppressUserConversions,
3783                   bool InOverloadResolution,
3784                   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
3785   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
3786   //   When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
3787   //   special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
3788 
3789   ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
3790   Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
3791 
3792   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
3793   //   If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
3794   //   all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
3795   //   conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
3796   //   element of the list to X.
3797   // FIXME: Recognize std::initializer_list.
3798   // FIXME: Arrays don't make sense until we can deal with references.
3799   if (ToType->isArrayType())
3800     return Result;
3801 
3802   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
3803   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
3804   //   resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
3805   //   conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
3806   //   constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
3807   //   implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
3808   // FIXME: Implement this.
3809   if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType())
3810     return Result;
3811 
3812   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
3813   //   Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
3814   //   initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
3815   //   sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
3816   // FIXME: Implement this.
3817   if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
3818     return Result;
3819   }
3820 
3821   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
3822   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
3823   // FIXME: Implement this.
3824   if (ToType->isReferenceType())
3825     return Result;
3826 
3827   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
3828   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
3829   if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
3830     //    - if the initializer list has one element, the implicit conversion
3831     //      sequence is the one required to convert the element to the
3832     //      parameter type.
3833     // FIXME: Catch narrowing here?
3834     unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
3835     if (NumInits == 1)
3836       Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
3837                                      SuppressUserConversions,
3838                                      InOverloadResolution,
3839                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
3840     //    - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
3841     //      sequence is the identity conversion.
3842     else if (NumInits == 0) {
3843       Result.setStandard();
3844       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3845     }
3846     return Result;
3847   }
3848 
3849   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
3850   //   In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
3851   return Result;
3852 }
3853 
3854 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
3855 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
3856 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
3857 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
3858 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
3859 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
3860 static ImplicitConversionSequence
3861 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3862                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
3863                       bool InOverloadResolution,
3864                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
3865   if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
3866     return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
3867                              InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
3868 
3869   if (ToType->isReferenceType())
3870     return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
3871                             /*FIXME:*/From->getLocStart(),
3872                             SuppressUserConversions,
3873                             /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
3874 
3875   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
3876                                SuppressUserConversions,
3877                                /*AllowExplicit=*/false,
3878                                InOverloadResolution,
3879                                /*CStyle=*/false,
3880                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
3881 }
3882 
3883 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
3884                                   const CanQualType ToQTy,
3885                                   Sema &S,
3886                                   SourceLocation Loc,
3887                                   ExprValueKind FromVK) {
3888   OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
3889   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
3890     TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
3891 
3892   return !ICS.isBad();
3893 }
3894 
3895 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
3896 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
3897 /// expression @p From.
3898 static ImplicitConversionSequence
3899 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, QualType OrigFromType,
3900                                 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
3901                                 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
3902                                 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
3903   QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
3904   // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
3905   //                 const volatile object.
3906   unsigned Quals = isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method) ?
3907     Qualifiers::Const | Qualifiers::Volatile : Method->getTypeQualifiers();
3908   QualType ImplicitParamType =  S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
3909 
3910   // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
3911   // to exit early.
3912   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3913 
3914   // We need to have an object of class type.
3915   QualType FromType = OrigFromType;
3916   if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3917     FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
3918 
3919     // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
3920     // better have an lvalue.
3921     assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
3922   }
3923 
3924   assert(FromType->isRecordType());
3925 
3926   // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
3927   //   For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
3928   //   parameter is
3929   //
3930   //     - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
3931   //        ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
3932   //     - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
3933   //        ref-qualifier
3934   //
3935   // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
3936   // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
3937   //
3938   // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
3939   // are not allowed to create temporaries or perform user-defined conversions
3940   // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
3941   // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
3942   // non-constant references.
3943 
3944   // First check the qualifiers.
3945   QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
3946   if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
3947                                     != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
3948       !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
3949     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
3950                OrigFromType, ImplicitParamType);
3951     return ICS;
3952   }
3953 
3954   // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
3955   // affects the conversion rank.
3956   QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
3957   ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
3958   if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
3959     SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
3960   } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(FromType, ClassType))
3961     SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
3962   else {
3963     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
3964                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
3965     return ICS;
3966   }
3967 
3968   // Check the ref-qualifier.
3969   switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
3970   case RQ_None:
3971     // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
3972     break;
3973 
3974   case RQ_LValue:
3975     if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && Quals != Qualifiers::Const) {
3976       // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
3977       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
3978                  ImplicitParamType);
3979       return ICS;
3980     }
3981     break;
3982 
3983   case RQ_RValue:
3984     if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
3985       // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
3986       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
3987                  ImplicitParamType);
3988       return ICS;
3989     }
3990     break;
3991   }
3992 
3993   // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
3994   ICS.setStandard();
3995   ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
3996   ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
3997   ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
3998   ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
3999   ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4000   ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
4001   ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
4002   ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4003   ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
4004   ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
4005     = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
4006   return ICS;
4007 }
4008 
4009 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
4010 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
4011 /// expression.
4012 ExprResult
4013 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
4014                                           NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
4015                                           NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
4016                                           CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
4017   QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
4018   QualType ImplicitParamRecordType  =
4019     Method->getThisType(Context)->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4020 
4021   Expr::Classification FromClassification;
4022   if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
4023     FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
4024     DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
4025     FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
4026   } else {
4027     FromRecordType = From->getType();
4028     DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
4029     FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
4030   }
4031 
4032   // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
4033   // the actual argument initialization.
4034   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
4035     = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(), FromClassification,
4036                                       Method, Method->getParent());
4037   if (ICS.isBad()) {
4038     if (ICS.Bad.Kind == BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers) {
4039       Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
4040       Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
4041       unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
4042       if (CVR) {
4043         Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4044              diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
4045           << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
4046           << From->getSourceRange();
4047         Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
4048           << Method->getDeclName();
4049         return ExprError();
4050       }
4051     }
4052 
4053     return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4054                 diag::err_implicit_object_parameter_init)
4055        << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType << From->getSourceRange();
4056   }
4057 
4058   if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4059     ExprResult FromRes =
4060       PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
4061     if (FromRes.isInvalid())
4062       return ExprError();
4063     From = FromRes.take();
4064   }
4065 
4066   if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType))
4067     From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_NoOp,
4068                       From->getType()->isPointerType() ? VK_RValue : VK_LValue).take();
4069   return Owned(From);
4070 }
4071 
4072 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
4073 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
4074 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4075 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
4076   // FIXME: This is pretty broken.
4077   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
4078                                // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4079                                /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4080                                /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
4081                                /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4082                                /*CStyle=*/false,
4083                                /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
4084 }
4085 
4086 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
4087 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
4088 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
4089   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
4090   if (!ICS.isBad())
4091     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
4092 
4093   if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
4094     return Diag(From->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4095                 diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
4096                   << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
4097   return ExprError();
4098 }
4099 
4100 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
4101 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them.  This may change
4102 /// the result type of the conversion sequence.
4103 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
4104   if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
4105     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
4106     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
4107     SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
4108   }
4109 }
4110 
4111 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
4112 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
4113 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4114 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
4115   // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
4116   QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
4117   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
4118     = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
4119                             // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
4120                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
4121                             /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
4122                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4123                             /*CStyle=*/false,
4124                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
4125 
4126   // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
4127   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4128   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4129   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
4130   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
4131     break;
4132 
4133   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
4134     dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
4135     break;
4136 
4137   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4138     dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
4139     break;
4140   }
4141 
4142   return ICS;
4143 }
4144 
4145 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
4146 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
4147 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
4148   QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
4149   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4150     TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
4151   if (!ICS.isBad())
4152     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
4153   return ExprError();
4154 }
4155 
4156 /// \brief Attempt to convert the given expression to an integral or
4157 /// enumeration type.
4158 ///
4159 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to an
4160 /// integral or enumeration type, if that class type only has a single
4161 /// conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
4162 ///
4163 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
4164 /// conversion.
4165 ///
4166 /// \param FromE The expression we're converting from.
4167 ///
4168 /// \param NotIntDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression does not
4169 /// have integral or enumeration type.
4170 ///
4171 /// \param IncompleteDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if the expression has
4172 /// incomplete class type.
4173 ///
4174 /// \param ExplicitConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we're calling an
4175 /// explicit conversion function (because no implicit conversion functions
4176 /// were available). This is a recovery mode.
4177 ///
4178 /// \param ExplicitConvNote The note to be emitted with \p ExplicitConvDiag,
4179 /// showing which conversion was picked.
4180 ///
4181 /// \param AmbigDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if there is more than one
4182 /// conversion function that could convert to integral or enumeration type.
4183 ///
4184 /// \param AmbigNote The note to be emitted with \p AmbigDiag for each
4185 /// usable conversion function.
4186 ///
4187 /// \param ConvDiag The diagnostic to be emitted if we are calling a conversion
4188 /// function, which may be an extension in this case.
4189 ///
4190 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
4191 /// successful.
4192 ExprResult
4193 Sema::ConvertToIntegralOrEnumerationType(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
4194                                          const PartialDiagnostic &NotIntDiag,
4195                                        const PartialDiagnostic &IncompleteDiag,
4196                                      const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvDiag,
4197                                      const PartialDiagnostic &ExplicitConvNote,
4198                                          const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigDiag,
4199                                          const PartialDiagnostic &AmbigNote,
4200                                          const PartialDiagnostic &ConvDiag) {
4201   // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
4202   if (From->isTypeDependent())
4203     return Owned(From);
4204 
4205   // If the expression already has integral or enumeration type, we're golden.
4206   QualType T = From->getType();
4207   if (T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
4208     return Owned(From);
4209 
4210   // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
4211 
4212   // If we don't have a class type in C++, there's no way we can get an
4213   // expression of integral or enumeration type.
4214   const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
4215   if (!RecordTy || !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4216     Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
4217       << T << From->getSourceRange();
4218     return Owned(From);
4219   }
4220 
4221   // We must have a complete class type.
4222   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiag))
4223     return Owned(From);
4224 
4225   // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
4226   UnresolvedSet<4> ViableConversions;
4227   UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
4228   const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
4229     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4230 
4231   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (Conversions->size() > 1);
4232 
4233   for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
4234                                    E = Conversions->end();
4235        I != E;
4236        ++I) {
4237     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
4238           = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
4239       if (Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType()
4240             ->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()) {
4241         if (Conversion->isExplicit())
4242           ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
4243         else
4244           ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
4245       }
4246   }
4247 
4248   switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
4249   case 0:
4250     if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1) {
4251       DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
4252       CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
4253         = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
4254 
4255       // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
4256       // conversion; use it.
4257       QualType ConvTy
4258         = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
4259       std::string TypeStr;
4260       ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, getPrintingPolicy());
4261 
4262       Diag(Loc, ExplicitConvDiag)
4263         << T << ConvTy
4264         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getLocStart(),
4265                                       "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
4266         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(PP.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getLocEnd()),
4267                                       ")");
4268       Diag(Conversion->getLocation(), ExplicitConvNote)
4269         << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
4270 
4271       // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
4272       // explicit conversion function.
4273       if (isSFINAEContext())
4274         return ExprError();
4275 
4276       CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
4277       ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
4278                                                  HadMultipleCandidates);
4279       if (Result.isInvalid())
4280         return ExprError();
4281 
4282       From = Result.get();
4283     }
4284 
4285     // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
4286     break;
4287 
4288   case 1: {
4289     // Apply this conversion.
4290     DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
4291     CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, 0, Found);
4292 
4293     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
4294       = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
4295     QualType ConvTy
4296       = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
4297     if (ConvDiag.getDiagID()) {
4298       if (isSFINAEContext())
4299         return ExprError();
4300 
4301       Diag(Loc, ConvDiag)
4302         << T << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy << From->getSourceRange();
4303     }
4304 
4305     ExprResult Result = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
4306                                                HadMultipleCandidates);
4307     if (Result.isInvalid())
4308       return ExprError();
4309 
4310     From = Result.get();
4311     break;
4312   }
4313 
4314   default:
4315     Diag(Loc, AmbigDiag)
4316       << T << From->getSourceRange();
4317     for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
4318       CXXConversionDecl *Conv
4319         = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
4320       QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
4321       Diag(Conv->getLocation(), AmbigNote)
4322         << ConvTy->isEnumeralType() << ConvTy;
4323     }
4324     return Owned(From);
4325   }
4326 
4327   if (!From->getType()->isIntegralOrEnumerationType())
4328     Diag(Loc, NotIntDiag)
4329       << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
4330 
4331   return Owned(From);
4332 }
4333 
4334 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
4335 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments.  If
4336 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
4337 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
4338 ///
4339 /// \para PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
4340 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
4341 /// code completion.
4342 void
4343 Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Function,
4344                            DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
4345                            Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4346                            OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4347                            bool SuppressUserConversions,
4348                            bool PartialOverloading) {
4349   const FunctionProtoType* Proto
4350     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
4351   assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
4352   assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
4353          "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
4354 
4355   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
4356     if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
4357       // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
4358       // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
4359       // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
4360       // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
4361       // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
4362       // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
4363       // is irrelevant.
4364       AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(),
4365                          QualType(), Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(),
4366                          Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
4367                          SuppressUserConversions);
4368       return;
4369     }
4370     // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
4371     // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
4372   }
4373 
4374   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function))
4375     return;
4376 
4377   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
4378   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
4379 
4380   if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function)){
4381     // C++ [class.copy]p3:
4382     //   A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
4383     //   of a class object to an object of its class type.
4384     QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
4385     if (NumArgs == 1 &&
4386         Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
4387         (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
4388          IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getType(), ClassType)))
4389       return;
4390   }
4391 
4392   // Add this candidate
4393   CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4394   OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4395   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4396   Candidate.Function = Function;
4397   Candidate.Viable = true;
4398   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4399   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
4400   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
4401 
4402   unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4403 
4404   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4405   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4406   // list (8.3.5).
4407   if ((NumArgs + (PartialOverloading && NumArgs)) > NumArgsInProto &&
4408       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4409     Candidate.Viable = false;
4410     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
4411     return;
4412   }
4413 
4414   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
4415   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
4416   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
4417   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
4418   // exactly m parameters.
4419   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
4420   if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
4421     // Not enough arguments.
4422     Candidate.Viable = false;
4423     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
4424     return;
4425   }
4426 
4427   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
4428   if (getLangOptions().CUDA)
4429     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
4430       if (CheckCUDATarget(Caller, Function)) {
4431         Candidate.Viable = false;
4432         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
4433         return;
4434       }
4435 
4436   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4437   // arguments.
4438   Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
4439   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4440     if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4441       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4442       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4443       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4444       // parameter of F.
4445       QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
4446       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
4447         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
4448                                 SuppressUserConversions,
4449                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
4450                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
4451                                   getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4452       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
4453         Candidate.Viable = false;
4454         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
4455         break;
4456       }
4457     } else {
4458       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4459       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4460       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
4461       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].setEllipsis();
4462     }
4463   }
4464 }
4465 
4466 /// \brief Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
4467 /// the overload canddiate set.
4468 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
4469                                  Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4470                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4471                                  bool SuppressUserConversions) {
4472   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
4473     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
4474     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
4475       if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic())
4476         AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
4477                            cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(),
4478                            Args[0]->getType(), Args[0]->Classify(Context),
4479                            Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
4480                            CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
4481       else
4482         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
4483                              SuppressUserConversions);
4484     } else {
4485       FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4486       if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4487           !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl())->isStatic())
4488         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
4489                               cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
4490                                    /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
4491                                    Args[0]->getType(),
4492                                    Args[0]->Classify(Context),
4493                                    Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
4494                                    CandidateSet,
4495                                    SuppressUserConversions);
4496       else
4497         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
4498                                      /*FIXME: explicit args */ 0,
4499                                      Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
4500                                      SuppressUserConversions);
4501     }
4502   }
4503 }
4504 
4505 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
4506 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
4507 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
4508                               QualType ObjectType,
4509                               Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
4510                               Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4511                               OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4512                               bool SuppressUserConversions) {
4513   NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
4514   CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
4515 
4516   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
4517     Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
4518 
4519   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
4520     assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4521            "Expected a member function template");
4522     AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
4523                                /*ExplicitArgs*/ 0,
4524                                ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
4525                                CandidateSet,
4526                                SuppressUserConversions);
4527   } else {
4528     AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
4529                        ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, NumArgs,
4530                        CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
4531   }
4532 }
4533 
4534 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
4535 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
4536 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
4537 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
4538 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
4539 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
4540 /// operators.
4541 void
4542 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
4543                          CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
4544                          Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
4545                          Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4546                          OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4547                          bool SuppressUserConversions) {
4548   const FunctionProtoType* Proto
4549     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
4550   assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
4551   assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
4552          "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
4553 
4554   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method))
4555     return;
4556 
4557   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
4558   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
4559 
4560   // Add this candidate
4561   CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4562   OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4563   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4564   Candidate.Function = Method;
4565   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4566   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
4567   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
4568 
4569   unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4570 
4571   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4572   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4573   // list (8.3.5).
4574   if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4575     Candidate.Viable = false;
4576     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
4577     return;
4578   }
4579 
4580   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
4581   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
4582   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
4583   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
4584   // exactly m parameters.
4585   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
4586   if (NumArgs < MinRequiredArgs) {
4587     // Not enough arguments.
4588     Candidate.Viable = false;
4589     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
4590     return;
4591   }
4592 
4593   Candidate.Viable = true;
4594   Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
4595 
4596   if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
4597     // The implicit object argument is ignored.
4598     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
4599   else {
4600     // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
4601     // parameter.
4602     Candidate.Conversions[0]
4603       = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4604                                         Method, ActingContext);
4605     if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
4606       Candidate.Viable = false;
4607       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
4608       return;
4609     }
4610   }
4611 
4612   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
4613   // arguments.
4614   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
4615     if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
4616       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
4617       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
4618       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
4619       // parameter of F.
4620       QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
4621       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
4622         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
4623                                 SuppressUserConversions,
4624                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
4625                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
4626                                   getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
4627       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
4628         Candidate.Viable = false;
4629         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
4630         break;
4631       }
4632     } else {
4633       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
4634       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
4635       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
4636       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
4637     }
4638   }
4639 }
4640 
4641 /// \brief Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
4642 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
4643 /// function template specialization.
4644 void
4645 Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl,
4646                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
4647                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
4648                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
4649                                  QualType ObjectType,
4650                                  Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
4651                                  Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4652                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4653                                  bool SuppressUserConversions) {
4654   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl))
4655     return;
4656 
4657   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
4658   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
4659   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
4660   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
4661   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4662   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4663   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4664   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4665   //   functions.
4666   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
4667   FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4668   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
4669       = DeduceTemplateArguments(MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
4670                                 Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
4671     CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4672     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4673     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4674     Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
4675     Candidate.Viable = false;
4676     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4677     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4678     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
4679     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
4680     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
4681                                                           Info);
4682     return;
4683   }
4684 
4685   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4686   // deduction as a candidate.
4687   assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
4688   assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
4689          "Specialization is not a member function?");
4690   AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
4691                      ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
4692                      Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions);
4693 }
4694 
4695 /// \brief Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
4696 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
4697 /// an appropriate function template specialization.
4698 void
4699 Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
4700                                    DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
4701                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
4702                                    Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4703                                    OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
4704                                    bool SuppressUserConversions) {
4705   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4706     return;
4707 
4708   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
4709   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
4710   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
4711   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
4712   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
4713   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
4714   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
4715   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
4716   //   functions.
4717   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
4718   FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4719   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
4720         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
4721                                   Args, NumArgs, Specialization, Info)) {
4722     CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4723     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4724     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4725     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4726     Candidate.Viable = false;
4727     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4728     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4729     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
4730     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
4731     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
4732                                                           Info);
4733     return;
4734   }
4735 
4736   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
4737   // deduction as a candidate.
4738   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
4739   AddOverloadCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
4740                        SuppressUserConversions);
4741 }
4742 
4743 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
4744 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
4745 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
4746 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
4747 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
4748 /// conversion function produces).
4749 void
4750 Sema::AddConversionCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
4751                              DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
4752                              CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
4753                              Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4754                              OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
4755   assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
4756          "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
4757   QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
4758   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4759     return;
4760 
4761   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
4762   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
4763 
4764   // Add this candidate
4765   CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4766   OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4767   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4768   Candidate.Function = Conversion;
4769   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4770   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
4771   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
4772   Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
4773   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
4774   Candidate.Viable = true;
4775   Candidate.Conversions.resize(1);
4776   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
4777 
4778   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
4779   //   For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
4780   //   the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
4781   //   defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
4782   //
4783   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4784   // object parameter.
4785   QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
4786   if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
4787     ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
4788   CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
4789     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4790 
4791   Candidate.Conversions[0]
4792     = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, From->getType(),
4793                                       From->Classify(Context),
4794                                       Conversion, ConversionContext);
4795 
4796   if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
4797     Candidate.Viable = false;
4798     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
4799     return;
4800   }
4801 
4802   // We won't go through a user-define type conversion function to convert a
4803   // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
4804   // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
4805   QualType FromCanon
4806     = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
4807   QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
4808   if (FromCanon == ToCanon || IsDerivedFrom(FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
4809     Candidate.Viable = false;
4810     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
4811     return;
4812   }
4813 
4814   // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
4815   // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
4816   // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
4817   // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
4818   // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
4819   // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
4820   // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
4821   // well-formed.
4822   DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Conversion, Conversion->getType(),
4823                             VK_LValue, From->getLocStart());
4824   ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
4825                                 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
4826                                 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay,
4827                                 &ConversionRef, VK_RValue);
4828 
4829   QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
4830   if (RequireCompleteType(From->getLocStart(), ConversionType, 0)) {
4831     Candidate.Viable = false;
4832     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4833     return;
4834   }
4835 
4836   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
4837 
4838   // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
4839   // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
4840   // allocator).
4841   QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
4842   CallExpr Call(Context, &ConversionFn, 0, 0, CallResultType, VK,
4843                 From->getLocStart());
4844   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
4845     TryCopyInitialization(*this, &Call, ToType,
4846                           /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
4847                           /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4848                           /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
4849 
4850   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
4851   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
4852     Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
4853 
4854     // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
4855     //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
4856     //   conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
4857     //   shall have exact match rank.
4858     if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
4859         GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
4860       Candidate.Viable = false;
4861       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
4862     }
4863 
4864     // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4865     //    In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
4866     //    the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
4867     //    conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
4868     //    program is ill-formed.
4869     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
4870         ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
4871       Candidate.Viable = false;
4872       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4873     }
4874     break;
4875 
4876   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
4877     Candidate.Viable = false;
4878     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
4879     break;
4880 
4881   default:
4882     llvm_unreachable(
4883            "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
4884   }
4885 }
4886 
4887 /// \brief Adds a conversion function template specialization
4888 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
4889 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
4890 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
4891 /// [temp.deduct.conv]).
4892 void
4893 Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate,
4894                                      DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
4895                                      CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC,
4896                                      Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4897                                      OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
4898   assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
4899          "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
4900 
4901   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
4902     return;
4903 
4904   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, CandidateSet.getLocation());
4905   CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = 0;
4906   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
4907         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
4908                                   Specialization, Info)) {
4909     CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4910     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4911     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4912     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
4913     Candidate.Viable = false;
4914     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
4915     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
4916     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
4917     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
4918     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
4919                                                           Info);
4920     return;
4921   }
4922 
4923   // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
4924   // template argument deduction as a candidate.
4925   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
4926   AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
4927                          CandidateSet);
4928 }
4929 
4930 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
4931 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
4932 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
4933 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
4934 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
4935 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
4936                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
4937                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
4938                                  const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
4939                                  Expr *Object,
4940                                  Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4941                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
4942   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
4943     return;
4944 
4945   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
4946   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
4947 
4948   CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
4949   OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
4950   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
4951   Candidate.Function = 0;
4952   Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
4953   Candidate.Viable = true;
4954   Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
4955   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
4956   Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs + 1);
4957   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
4958 
4959   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
4960   // object parameter.
4961   ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit
4962     = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(*this, Object->getType(),
4963                                       Object->Classify(Context),
4964                                       Conversion, ActingContext);
4965   if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
4966     Candidate.Viable = false;
4967     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
4968     Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
4969     return;
4970   }
4971 
4972   // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
4973   // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
4974   // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
4975   Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
4976   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
4977   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4978   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
4979   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
4980   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
4981   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
4982     = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
4983   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
4984 
4985   // Find the
4986   unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
4987 
4988   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
4989   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
4990   // list (8.3.5).
4991   if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
4992     Candidate.Viable = false;
4993     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
4994     return;
4995   }
4996 
4997   // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
4998   // we have enough arguments.
4999   if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
5000     // Not enough arguments.
5001     Candidate.Viable = false;
5002     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
5003     return;
5004   }
5005 
5006   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5007   // arguments.
5008   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5009     if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
5010       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
5011       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
5012       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
5013       // parameter of F.
5014       QualType ParamType = Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx);
5015       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
5016         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
5017                                 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5018                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5019                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5020                                   getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
5021       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
5022         Candidate.Viable = false;
5023         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
5024         break;
5025       }
5026     } else {
5027       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
5028       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
5029       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
5030       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
5031     }
5032   }
5033 }
5034 
5035 /// \brief Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
5036 /// member functions.
5037 ///
5038 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
5039 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
5040 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
5041 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
5042 /// [over.match.oper]).
5043 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
5044                                        SourceLocation OpLoc,
5045                                        Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5046                                        OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5047                                        SourceRange OpRange) {
5048   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
5049 
5050   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
5051   //   For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
5052   //   cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
5053   //   a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
5054   //   a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
5055   //   three sets of candidate functions, designated member
5056   //   candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
5057   //   constructed as follows:
5058   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
5059 
5060   //     -- If T1 is a class type, the set of member candidates is the
5061   //        result of the qualified lookup of T1::operator@
5062   //        (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise, the set of member candidates is
5063   //        empty.
5064   if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
5065     // Complete the type if it can be completed. Otherwise, we're done.
5066     if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, T1, PDiag()))
5067       return;
5068 
5069     LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
5070     LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
5071     Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
5072 
5073     for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
5074                              OperEnd = Operators.end();
5075          Oper != OperEnd;
5076          ++Oper)
5077       AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
5078                          Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args + 1, NumArgs - 1,
5079                          CandidateSet,
5080                          /* SuppressUserConversions = */ false);
5081   }
5082 }
5083 
5084 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
5085 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
5086 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
5087 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
5088 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
5089 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
5090 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
5091 /// converted to bool.
5092 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType ResultTy, QualType *ParamTys,
5093                                Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5094                                OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
5095                                bool IsAssignmentOperator,
5096                                unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
5097   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
5098   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(*this, Sema::Unevaluated);
5099 
5100   // Add this candidate
5101   CandidateSet.push_back(OverloadCandidate());
5102   OverloadCandidate& Candidate = CandidateSet.back();
5103   Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_none);
5104   Candidate.Function = 0;
5105   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
5106   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
5107   Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ResultTy = ResultTy;
5108   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
5109     Candidate.BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ArgIdx] = ParamTys[ArgIdx];
5110 
5111   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
5112   // arguments.
5113   Candidate.Viable = true;
5114   Candidate.Conversions.resize(NumArgs);
5115   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = NumArgs;
5116   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5117     // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
5118     //   For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
5119     //   left operand are restricted as follows:
5120     //     -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
5121     //     -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
5122     //        operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
5123     //        parameter of a built-in candidate.
5124     //
5125     // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
5126     // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
5127     // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
5128     // is not of the same type.
5129     if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
5130       assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
5131              "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
5132       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
5133         = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
5134     } else {
5135       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
5136         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
5137                                 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
5138                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5139                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
5140                                   getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
5141     }
5142     if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
5143       Candidate.Viable = false;
5144       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
5145       break;
5146     }
5147   }
5148 }
5149 
5150 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
5151 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
5152 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
5153 /// enumeration types.
5154 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet  {
5155   /// TypeSet - A set of types.
5156   typedef llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> TypeSet;
5157 
5158   /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
5159   /// built-in candidates.
5160   TypeSet PointerTypes;
5161 
5162   /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
5163   /// used in the built-in candidates.
5164   TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
5165 
5166   /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
5167   /// used in the built-in candidates.
5168   TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
5169 
5170   /// \brief The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
5171   /// candidates.
5172   TypeSet VectorTypes;
5173 
5174   /// \brief A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
5175   bool HasNonRecordTypes;
5176 
5177   /// \brief A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
5178   /// were present in the candidate set.
5179   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
5180 
5181   /// \brief A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
5182   /// candidate set.
5183   bool HasNullPtrType;
5184 
5185   /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
5186   /// candidate type set.
5187   Sema &SemaRef;
5188 
5189   /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
5190   ASTContext &Context;
5191 
5192   bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
5193                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
5194   bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
5195 
5196 public:
5197   /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
5198   typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
5199 
5200   BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
5201     : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
5202       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
5203       HasNullPtrType(false),
5204       SemaRef(SemaRef),
5205       Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
5206 
5207   void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
5208                              SourceLocation Loc,
5209                              bool AllowUserConversions,
5210                              bool AllowExplicitConversions,
5211                              const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
5212 
5213   /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
5214   iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
5215 
5216   /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
5217   iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
5218 
5219   /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
5220   iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
5221 
5222   /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
5223   iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
5224 
5225   /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
5226   iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
5227 
5228   /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
5229   iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
5230 
5231   iterator vector_begin() { return VectorTypes.begin(); }
5232   iterator vector_end() { return VectorTypes.end(); }
5233 
5234   bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
5235   bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
5236   bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
5237 };
5238 
5239 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
5240 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
5241 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
5242 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
5243 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
5244 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
5245 /// false otherwise.
5246 ///
5247 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
5248 bool
5249 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
5250                                              const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
5251 
5252   // Insert this type.
5253   if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
5254     return false;
5255 
5256   QualType PointeeTy;
5257   const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
5258   bool buildObjCPtr = false;
5259   if (!PointerTy) {
5260     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
5261       PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
5262       buildObjCPtr = true;
5263     }
5264     else
5265       llvm_unreachable("type was not a pointer type!");
5266   }
5267   else
5268     PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
5269 
5270   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
5271   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
5272   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
5273   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
5274   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
5275     return true;
5276   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
5277   if (const ConstantArrayType *Array =Context.getAsConstantArrayType(PointeeTy))
5278     BaseCVR = Array->getElementType().getCVRQualifiers();
5279   bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
5280   bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
5281 
5282   // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
5283   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
5284     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
5285     // Skip over Volatile/Restrict if no Volatile/Restrict found anywhere
5286     // in the types.
5287     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
5288     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) && !hasRestrict) continue;
5289     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
5290     if (!buildObjCPtr)
5291       PointerTypes.insert(Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy));
5292     else
5293       PointerTypes.insert(Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy));
5294   }
5295 
5296   return true;
5297 }
5298 
5299 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
5300 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
5301 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
5302 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
5303 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
5304 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
5305 /// false otherwise.
5306 ///
5307 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
5308 bool
5309 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
5310     QualType Ty) {
5311   // Insert this type.
5312   if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
5313     return false;
5314 
5315   const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
5316   assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
5317 
5318   QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
5319   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
5320   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
5321   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
5322   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
5323   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
5324     return true;
5325   const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
5326 
5327   // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
5328   // qualifiers.
5329   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
5330   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
5331     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
5332 
5333     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
5334     MemberPointerTypes.insert(
5335       Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
5336   }
5337 
5338   return true;
5339 }
5340 
5341 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
5342 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
5343 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
5344 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
5345 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
5346 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
5347 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
5348 /// type.
5349 void
5350 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
5351                                                SourceLocation Loc,
5352                                                bool AllowUserConversions,
5353                                                bool AllowExplicitConversions,
5354                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
5355   // Only deal with canonical types.
5356   Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
5357 
5358   // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
5359   // expression for the purposes of conversions.
5360   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
5361     Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
5362 
5363   // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
5364   if (Ty->isArrayType())
5365     Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
5366 
5367   // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
5368   Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
5369 
5370   // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
5371   const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
5372   HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
5373 
5374   // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
5375   HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
5376     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
5377 
5378   if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
5379     PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
5380   else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
5381     // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
5382     // of types.
5383     if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
5384       return;
5385   } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
5386     // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
5387     if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
5388       return;
5389   } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
5390     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
5391     EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
5392   } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
5393     // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
5394     // extension.
5395     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
5396     VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
5397   } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
5398     HasNullPtrType = true;
5399   } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
5400     // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
5401     if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(Loc, Ty, 0))
5402       return;
5403 
5404     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
5405     const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
5406       = ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
5407     for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
5408            E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
5409       NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
5410       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5411         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5412 
5413       // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
5414       // about which builtin types we can convert to.
5415       if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
5416         continue;
5417 
5418       CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5419       if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
5420         AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
5421                               VisibleQuals);
5422       }
5423     }
5424   }
5425 }
5426 
5427 /// \brief Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
5428 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
5429 /// given type to the candidate set.
5430 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
5431                                                    QualType T,
5432                                                    Expr **Args,
5433                                                    unsigned NumArgs,
5434                                     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5435   QualType ParamTypes[2];
5436 
5437   // T& operator=(T&, T)
5438   ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
5439   ParamTypes[1] = T;
5440   S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5441                         /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
5442 
5443   if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
5444     // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
5445     ParamTypes[0]
5446       = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(T));
5447     ParamTypes[1] = T;
5448     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
5449                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
5450   }
5451 }
5452 
5453 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
5454 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
5455 static  Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
5456     Qualifiers VRQuals;
5457     const RecordType *TyRec;
5458     if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
5459         ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
5460       TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
5461     else
5462       TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
5463     if (!TyRec) {
5464       // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
5465       VRQuals.addVolatile();
5466       VRQuals.addRestrict();
5467       return VRQuals;
5468     }
5469 
5470     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
5471     if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
5472       return VRQuals;
5473 
5474     const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions =
5475       ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
5476 
5477     for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
5478            E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
5479       NamedDecl *D = I.getDecl();
5480       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5481         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5482       if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
5483         QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
5484         if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
5485           CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
5486         // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
5487         // as see them.
5488         bool done = false;
5489         while (!done) {
5490           if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
5491             CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
5492           else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
5493                 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
5494             CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
5495           else
5496             done = true;
5497           if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
5498             VRQuals.addVolatile();
5499           if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
5500             VRQuals.addRestrict();
5501           if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
5502             return VRQuals;
5503         }
5504       }
5505     }
5506     return VRQuals;
5507 }
5508 
5509 namespace {
5510 
5511 /// \brief Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
5512 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
5513 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
5514 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
5515 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
5516   // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
5517   Sema &S;
5518   Expr **Args;
5519   unsigned NumArgs;
5520   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
5521   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
5522   SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
5523   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
5524 
5525   // Define some constants used to index and iterate over the arithemetic types
5526   // provided via the getArithmeticType() method below.
5527   // The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
5528   // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
5529   static const unsigned FirstIntegralType = 3;
5530   static const unsigned LastIntegralType = 18;
5531   static const unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType = 3,
5532                         LastPromotedIntegralType = 9;
5533   static const unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0,
5534                         LastPromotedArithmeticType = 9;
5535   static const unsigned NumArithmeticTypes = 18;
5536 
5537   /// \brief Get the canonical type for a given arithmetic type index.
5538   CanQualType getArithmeticType(unsigned index) {
5539     assert(index < NumArithmeticTypes);
5540     static CanQualType ASTContext::* const
5541       ArithmeticTypes[NumArithmeticTypes] = {
5542       // Start of promoted types.
5543       &ASTContext::FloatTy,
5544       &ASTContext::DoubleTy,
5545       &ASTContext::LongDoubleTy,
5546 
5547       // Start of integral types.
5548       &ASTContext::IntTy,
5549       &ASTContext::LongTy,
5550       &ASTContext::LongLongTy,
5551       &ASTContext::UnsignedIntTy,
5552       &ASTContext::UnsignedLongTy,
5553       &ASTContext::UnsignedLongLongTy,
5554       // End of promoted types.
5555 
5556       &ASTContext::BoolTy,
5557       &ASTContext::CharTy,
5558       &ASTContext::WCharTy,
5559       &ASTContext::Char16Ty,
5560       &ASTContext::Char32Ty,
5561       &ASTContext::SignedCharTy,
5562       &ASTContext::ShortTy,
5563       &ASTContext::UnsignedCharTy,
5564       &ASTContext::UnsignedShortTy,
5565       // End of integral types.
5566       // FIXME: What about complex?
5567     };
5568     return S.Context.*ArithmeticTypes[index];
5569   }
5570 
5571   /// \brief Gets the canonical type resulting from the usual arithemetic
5572   /// converions for the given arithmetic types.
5573   CanQualType getUsualArithmeticConversions(unsigned L, unsigned R) {
5574     // Accelerator table for performing the usual arithmetic conversions.
5575     // The rules are basically:
5576     //   - if either is floating-point, use the wider floating-point
5577     //   - if same signedness, use the higher rank
5578     //   - if same size, use unsigned of the higher rank
5579     //   - use the larger type
5580     // These rules, together with the axiom that higher ranks are
5581     // never smaller, are sufficient to precompute all of these results
5582     // *except* when dealing with signed types of higher rank.
5583     // (we could precompute SLL x UI for all known platforms, but it's
5584     // better not to make any assumptions).
5585     enum PromotedType {
5586                   Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   SI,   SL,  SLL,   UI,   UL,  ULL, Dep=-1
5587     };
5588     static PromotedType ConversionsTable[LastPromotedArithmeticType]
5589                                         [LastPromotedArithmeticType] = {
5590       /* Flt*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt,  Flt },
5591       /* Dbl*/ {  Dbl,  Dbl, LDbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl,  Dbl },
5592       /*LDbl*/ { LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl, LDbl },
5593       /*  SI*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   SI,   SL,  SLL,   UI,   UL,  ULL },
5594       /*  SL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   SL,   SL,  SLL,  Dep,   UL,  ULL },
5595       /* SLL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,  SLL,  SLL,  SLL,  Dep,  Dep,  ULL },
5596       /*  UI*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   UI,  Dep,  Dep,   UI,   UL,  ULL },
5597       /*  UL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,   UL,   UL,  Dep,   UL,   UL,  ULL },
5598       /* ULL*/ {  Flt,  Dbl, LDbl,  ULL,  ULL,  ULL,  ULL,  ULL,  ULL },
5599     };
5600 
5601     assert(L < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5602     assert(R < LastPromotedArithmeticType);
5603     int Idx = ConversionsTable[L][R];
5604 
5605     // Fast path: the table gives us a concrete answer.
5606     if (Idx != Dep) return getArithmeticType(Idx);
5607 
5608     // Slow path: we need to compare widths.
5609     // An invariant is that the signed type has higher rank.
5610     CanQualType LT = getArithmeticType(L),
5611                 RT = getArithmeticType(R);
5612     unsigned LW = S.Context.getIntWidth(LT),
5613              RW = S.Context.getIntWidth(RT);
5614 
5615     // If they're different widths, use the signed type.
5616     if (LW > RW) return LT;
5617     else if (LW < RW) return RT;
5618 
5619     // Otherwise, use the unsigned type of the signed type's rank.
5620     if (L == SL || R == SL) return S.Context.UnsignedLongTy;
5621     assert(L == SLL || R == SLL);
5622     return S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
5623   }
5624 
5625   /// \brief Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
5626   /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
5627   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
5628                                            bool HasVolatile) {
5629     QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
5630       S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
5631       S.Context.IntTy
5632     };
5633 
5634     // Non-volatile version.
5635     if (NumArgs == 1)
5636       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5637     else
5638       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5639 
5640     // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
5641     // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
5642     if (HasVolatile) {
5643       ParamTypes[0] =
5644         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
5645           S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
5646       if (NumArgs == 1)
5647         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5648       else
5649         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(CandidateTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
5650     }
5651   }
5652 
5653 public:
5654   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
5655     Sema &S, Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
5656     Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
5657     bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
5658     SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
5659     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
5660     : S(S), Args(Args), NumArgs(NumArgs),
5661       VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
5662       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
5663         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
5664       CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
5665       CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
5666     // Validate some of our static helper constants in debug builds.
5667     assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedIntegralType) == S.Context.IntTy &&
5668            "Invalid first promoted integral type");
5669     assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedIntegralType - 1)
5670              == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
5671            "Invalid last promoted integral type");
5672     assert(getArithmeticType(FirstPromotedArithmeticType)
5673              == S.Context.FloatTy &&
5674            "Invalid first promoted arithmetic type");
5675     assert(getArithmeticType(LastPromotedArithmeticType - 1)
5676              == S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy &&
5677            "Invalid last promoted arithmetic type");
5678   }
5679 
5680   // C++ [over.built]p3:
5681   //
5682   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type, and VQ
5683   //   is either volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator
5684   //   functions of the form
5685   //
5686   //       VQ T&      operator++(VQ T&);
5687   //       T          operator++(VQ T&, int);
5688   //
5689   // C++ [over.built]p4:
5690   //
5691   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
5692   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
5693   //   candidate operator functions of the form
5694   //
5695   //       VQ T&      operator--(VQ T&);
5696   //       T          operator--(VQ T&, int);
5697   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
5698     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5699       return;
5700 
5701     for (unsigned Arith = (Op == OO_PlusPlus? 0 : 1);
5702          Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
5703       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
5704         getArithmeticType(Arith),
5705         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile());
5706     }
5707   }
5708 
5709   // C++ [over.built]p5:
5710   //
5711   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
5712   //   cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
5713   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5714   //
5715   //       T*VQ&      operator++(T*VQ&);
5716   //       T*VQ&      operator--(T*VQ&);
5717   //       T*         operator++(T*VQ&, int);
5718   //       T*         operator--(T*VQ&, int);
5719   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
5720     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5721               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5722            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5723          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5724       // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
5725       if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
5726         continue;
5727 
5728       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
5729         (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
5730          VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()));
5731     }
5732   }
5733 
5734   // C++ [over.built]p6:
5735   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
5736   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
5737   //
5738   //       T&         operator*(T*);
5739   //
5740   // C++ [over.built]p7:
5741   //   For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
5742   //   ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5743   //       T&         operator*(T*);
5744   void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
5745     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5746               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5747            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5748          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5749       QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5750       QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
5751       if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5752         continue;
5753 
5754       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
5755         if (Proto->getTypeQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
5756           continue;
5757 
5758       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeTy),
5759                             &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5760     }
5761   }
5762 
5763   // C++ [over.built]p9:
5764   //  For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
5765   //  operator functions of the form
5766   //
5767   //       T         operator+(T);
5768   //       T         operator-(T);
5769   void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
5770     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5771       return;
5772 
5773     for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
5774          Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
5775       QualType ArithTy = getArithmeticType(Arith);
5776       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ArithTy, &ArithTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5777     }
5778 
5779     // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
5780     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5781               Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5782            VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5783          Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5784       QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5785       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5786     }
5787   }
5788 
5789   // C++ [over.built]p8:
5790   //   For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
5791   //   the form
5792   //
5793   //       T*         operator+(T*);
5794   void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
5795     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5796               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
5797            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
5798          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5799       QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
5800       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5801     }
5802   }
5803 
5804   // C++ [over.built]p10:
5805   //   For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
5806   //   operator functions of the form
5807   //
5808   //        T         operator~(T);
5809   void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
5810     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
5811       return;
5812 
5813     for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
5814          Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
5815       QualType IntTy = getArithmeticType(Int);
5816       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(IntTy, &IntTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5817     }
5818 
5819     // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
5820     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5821               Vec = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
5822            VecEnd = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
5823          Vec != VecEnd; ++Vec) {
5824       QualType VecTy = *Vec;
5825       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(VecTy, &VecTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet);
5826     }
5827   }
5828 
5829   // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
5830   //   For every pointer to member type T, there exist candidate operator
5831   //   functions of the form
5832   //
5833   //        bool operator==(T,T);
5834   //        bool operator!=(T,T);
5835   void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads() {
5836     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5837     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5838 
5839     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5840       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5841                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
5842              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
5843            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
5844            ++MemPtr) {
5845         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5846         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
5847           continue;
5848 
5849         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
5850         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5851                               CandidateSet);
5852       }
5853     }
5854   }
5855 
5856   // C++ [over.built]p15:
5857   //
5858   //   For every T, where T is an enumeration type, a pointer type, or
5859   //   std::nullptr_t, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5860   //
5861   //        bool       operator<(T, T);
5862   //        bool       operator>(T, T);
5863   //        bool       operator<=(T, T);
5864   //        bool       operator>=(T, T);
5865   //        bool       operator==(T, T);
5866   //        bool       operator!=(T, T);
5867   void addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
5868     // C++ [over.built]p1:
5869     //   If there is a user-written candidate with the same name and parameter
5870     //   types as a built-in candidate operator function, the built-in operator
5871     //   function is hidden and is not included in the set of candidate
5872     //   functions.
5873     //
5874     // The text is actually in a note, but if we don't implement it then we end
5875     // up with ambiguities when the user provides an overloaded operator for
5876     // an enumeration type. Note that only enumeration types have this problem,
5877     // so we track which enumeration types we've seen operators for. Also, the
5878     // only other overloaded operator with enumeration argumenst, operator=,
5879     // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
5880     // where we must suppress candidates like this.
5881     llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
5882       UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
5883 
5884     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5885       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
5886           CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
5887         for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
5888                                          CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
5889              C != CEnd; ++C) {
5890           if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
5891             continue;
5892 
5893           QualType FirstParamType =
5894             C->Function->getParamDecl(0)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5895           QualType SecondParamType =
5896             C->Function->getParamDecl(1)->getType().getUnqualifiedType();
5897 
5898           // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
5899           if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
5900               !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
5901             continue;
5902 
5903           // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
5904           UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
5905             std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
5906                            S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
5907         }
5908       }
5909     }
5910 
5911     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5912     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5913 
5914     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
5915       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5916                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
5917              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
5918            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5919         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
5920         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
5921           continue;
5922 
5923         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
5924         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5925                               CandidateSet);
5926       }
5927       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5928                 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
5929              EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
5930            Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
5931         CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
5932 
5933         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
5934         // candidate exists.
5935         if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType) ||
5936             UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
5937                                                             CanonType)))
5938           continue;
5939 
5940         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
5941         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5942                               CandidateSet);
5943       }
5944 
5945       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
5946         CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
5947         if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy) &&
5948             !UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(NullPtrTy,
5949                                                              NullPtrTy))) {
5950           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
5951           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2,
5952                                 CandidateSet);
5953         }
5954       }
5955     }
5956   }
5957 
5958   // C++ [over.built]p13:
5959   //
5960   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
5961   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
5962   //
5963   //      T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5964   //      T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);    [BELOW]
5965   //      T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
5966   //      T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5967   //      T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);    [BELOW]
5968   //
5969   // C++ [over.built]p14:
5970   //
5971   //   For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
5972   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
5973   //
5974   //      ptrdiff_t  operator-(T, T);
5975   void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
5976     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
5977     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
5978 
5979     for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
5980       QualType AsymetricParamTypes[2] = {
5981         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5982         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
5983       };
5984       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
5985                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
5986              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
5987            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
5988         QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
5989         if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
5990           continue;
5991 
5992         AsymetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
5993         if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
5994           // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
5995           // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
5996           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, AsymetricParamTypes, Args, 2,
5997                                 CandidateSet);
5998         }
5999         if (Op == OO_Minus) {
6000           // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
6001           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6002             continue;
6003 
6004           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6005           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), ParamTypes,
6006                                 Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6007         }
6008       }
6009     }
6010   }
6011 
6012   // C++ [over.built]p12:
6013   //
6014   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
6015   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
6016   //
6017   //        LR         operator*(L, R);
6018   //        LR         operator/(L, R);
6019   //        LR         operator+(L, R);
6020   //        LR         operator-(L, R);
6021   //        bool       operator<(L, R);
6022   //        bool       operator>(L, R);
6023   //        bool       operator<=(L, R);
6024   //        bool       operator>=(L, R);
6025   //        bool       operator==(L, R);
6026   //        bool       operator!=(L, R);
6027   //
6028   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6029   //   between types L and R.
6030   //
6031   // C++ [over.built]p24:
6032   //
6033   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
6034   //   candidate operator functions of the form
6035   //
6036   //        LR       operator?(bool, L, R);
6037   //
6038   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6039   //   between types L and R.
6040   // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
6041   void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(bool isComparison) {
6042     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6043       return;
6044 
6045     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6046          Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
6047       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6048            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
6049         QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
6050                               getArithmeticType(Right) };
6051         QualType Result =
6052           isComparison ? S.Context.BoolTy
6053                        : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
6054         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6055       }
6056     }
6057 
6058     // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
6059     // conditional operator for vector types.
6060     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6061               Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6062            Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6063          Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
6064       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6065                 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
6066              Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
6067            Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
6068         QualType LandR[2] = { *Vec1, *Vec2 };
6069         QualType Result = S.Context.BoolTy;
6070         if (!isComparison) {
6071           if ((*Vec1)->isExtVectorType() || !(*Vec2)->isExtVectorType())
6072             Result = *Vec1;
6073           else
6074             Result = *Vec2;
6075         }
6076 
6077         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6078       }
6079     }
6080   }
6081 
6082   // C++ [over.built]p17:
6083   //
6084   //   For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
6085   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
6086   //
6087   //      LR         operator%(L, R);
6088   //      LR         operator&(L, R);
6089   //      LR         operator^(L, R);
6090   //      LR         operator|(L, R);
6091   //      L          operator<<(L, R);
6092   //      L          operator>>(L, R);
6093   //
6094   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
6095   //   between types L and R.
6096   void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
6097     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6098       return;
6099 
6100     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6101          Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
6102       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6103            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
6104         QualType LandR[2] = { getArithmeticType(Left),
6105                               getArithmeticType(Right) };
6106         QualType Result = (Op == OO_LessLess || Op == OO_GreaterGreater)
6107             ? LandR[0]
6108             : getUsualArithmeticConversions(Left, Right);
6109         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(Result, LandR, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6110       }
6111     }
6112   }
6113 
6114   // C++ [over.built]p20:
6115   //
6116   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
6117   //   pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
6118   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6119   //
6120   //        VQ T&      operator=(VQ T&, T);
6121   void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
6122     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6123     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6124 
6125     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
6126       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6127                 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6128              EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6129            Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6130         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
6131           continue;
6132 
6133         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, 2,
6134                                                CandidateSet);
6135       }
6136 
6137       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6138                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6139              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6140            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
6141         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6142           continue;
6143 
6144         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, 2,
6145                                                CandidateSet);
6146       }
6147     }
6148   }
6149 
6150   // C++ [over.built]p19:
6151   //
6152   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
6153   //   volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
6154   //   of the form
6155   //
6156   //        T*VQ&      operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
6157   //
6158   // C++ [over.built]p21:
6159   //
6160   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
6161   //   cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
6162   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6163   //
6164   //        T*VQ&      operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
6165   //        T*VQ&      operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
6166   void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
6167     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6168     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6169 
6170     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6171               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6172            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6173          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6174       // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
6175       if (isEqualOp)
6176         AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
6177       else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
6178         continue;
6179 
6180       // non-volatile version
6181       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6182         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
6183         isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
6184       };
6185       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6186                             /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
6187 
6188       if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6189           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6190         // volatile version
6191         ParamTypes[0] =
6192           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
6193         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6194                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6195       }
6196     }
6197 
6198     if (isEqualOp) {
6199       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6200                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
6201              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
6202            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6203         // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
6204         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6205           continue;
6206 
6207         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
6208           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
6209           *Ptr,
6210         };
6211 
6212         // non-volatile version
6213         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6214                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
6215 
6216         if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
6217             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6218           // volatile version
6219           ParamTypes[0] =
6220             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
6221           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6222                                 CandidateSet, /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/true);
6223         }
6224       }
6225     }
6226   }
6227 
6228   // C++ [over.built]p18:
6229   //
6230   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
6231   //   VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
6232   //   arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
6233   //   the form
6234   //
6235   //        VQ L&      operator=(VQ L&, R);
6236   //        VQ L&      operator*=(VQ L&, R);
6237   //        VQ L&      operator/=(VQ L&, R);
6238   //        VQ L&      operator+=(VQ L&, R);
6239   //        VQ L&      operator-=(VQ L&, R);
6240   void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
6241     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6242       return;
6243 
6244     for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
6245       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
6246            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
6247         QualType ParamTypes[2];
6248         ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
6249 
6250         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6251         ParamTypes[0] =
6252           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
6253         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6254                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6255 
6256         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
6257         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6258           ParamTypes[0] =
6259             S.Context.getVolatileType(getArithmeticType(Left));
6260           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
6261           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6262                                 CandidateSet,
6263                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6264         }
6265       }
6266     }
6267 
6268     // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
6269     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6270               Vec1 = CandidateTypes[0].vector_begin(),
6271            Vec1End = CandidateTypes[0].vector_end();
6272          Vec1 != Vec1End; ++Vec1) {
6273       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6274                 Vec2 = CandidateTypes[1].vector_begin(),
6275              Vec2End = CandidateTypes[1].vector_end();
6276            Vec2 != Vec2End; ++Vec2) {
6277         QualType ParamTypes[2];
6278         ParamTypes[1] = *Vec2;
6279         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6280         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Vec1);
6281         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6282                               /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6283 
6284         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
6285         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6286           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(*Vec1);
6287           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
6288           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6289                                 CandidateSet,
6290                                 /*IsAssigmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
6291         }
6292       }
6293     }
6294   }
6295 
6296   // C++ [over.built]p22:
6297   //
6298   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
6299   //   is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
6300   //   type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6301   //
6302   //        VQ L&       operator%=(VQ L&, R);
6303   //        VQ L&       operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
6304   //        VQ L&       operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
6305   //        VQ L&       operator&=(VQ L&, R);
6306   //        VQ L&       operator^=(VQ L&, R);
6307   //        VQ L&       operator|=(VQ L&, R);
6308   void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
6309     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
6310       return;
6311 
6312     for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
6313       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
6314            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
6315         QualType ParamTypes[2];
6316         ParamTypes[1] = getArithmeticType(Right);
6317 
6318         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
6319         ParamTypes[0] =
6320           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(getArithmeticType(Left));
6321         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6322         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
6323           // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
6324           ParamTypes[0] = getArithmeticType(Left);
6325           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
6326           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
6327           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes[0], ParamTypes, Args, 2,
6328                                 CandidateSet);
6329         }
6330       }
6331     }
6332   }
6333 
6334   // C++ [over.operator]p23:
6335   //
6336   //   There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
6337   //
6338   //        bool        operator!(bool);
6339   //        bool        operator&&(bool, bool);
6340   //        bool        operator||(bool, bool);
6341   void addExclaimOverload() {
6342     QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
6343     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTy, &ParamTy, Args, 1, CandidateSet,
6344                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
6345                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
6346   }
6347   void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
6348     QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
6349     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(S.Context.BoolTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet,
6350                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
6351                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
6352   }
6353 
6354   // C++ [over.built]p13:
6355   //
6356   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
6357   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
6358   //
6359   //        T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
6360   //        T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
6361   //        T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
6362   //        T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);     [ABOVE]
6363   //        T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
6364   void addSubscriptOverloads() {
6365     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6366               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6367            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6368          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6369       QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
6370       QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
6371       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
6372         continue;
6373 
6374       QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
6375 
6376       // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
6377       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6378     }
6379 
6380     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6381               Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
6382            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
6383          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6384       QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
6385       QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
6386       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
6387         continue;
6388 
6389       QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(PointeeType);
6390 
6391       // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
6392       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6393     }
6394   }
6395 
6396   // C++ [over.built]p11:
6397   //    For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
6398   //    C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
6399   //    type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
6400   //    there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6401   //
6402   //      CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
6403   //
6404   //    where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
6405   void addArrowStarOverloads() {
6406     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6407              Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
6408            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
6409          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6410       QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
6411       QualType C1;
6412       QualifierCollector Q1;
6413       C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
6414       if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
6415         continue;
6416       // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
6417       // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
6418       // volatile/restrict type.
6419       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
6420         continue;
6421       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
6422         continue;
6423       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6424                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
6425              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
6426            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
6427         const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
6428         QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
6429         C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
6430         if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(C1, C2))
6431           break;
6432         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
6433         // build CV12 T&
6434         QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
6435         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
6436             T.isVolatileQualified())
6437           continue;
6438         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
6439             T.isRestrictQualified())
6440           continue;
6441         T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
6442         QualType ResultTy = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
6443         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ResultTy, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6444       }
6445     }
6446   }
6447 
6448   // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
6449   // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
6450   // therefore added as binary.
6451   //
6452   // C++ [over.built]p25:
6453   //   For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
6454   //   enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
6455   //
6456   //        T        operator?(bool, T, T);
6457   //
6458   void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
6459     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
6460     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
6461 
6462     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
6463       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6464                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
6465              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
6466            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
6467         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)))
6468           continue;
6469 
6470         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
6471         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Ptr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6472       }
6473 
6474       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6475                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
6476              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
6477            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
6478         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)))
6479           continue;
6480 
6481         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
6482         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*MemPtr, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6483       }
6484 
6485       if (S.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x) {
6486         for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
6487                   Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
6488                EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
6489              Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
6490           if (!(*Enum)->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
6491             continue;
6492 
6493           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)))
6494             continue;
6495 
6496           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
6497           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(*Enum, ParamTypes, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
6498         }
6499       }
6500     }
6501   }
6502 };
6503 
6504 } // end anonymous namespace
6505 
6506 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
6507 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
6508 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
6509 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
6510 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
6511 void
6512 Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
6513                                    SourceLocation OpLoc,
6514                                    Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6515                                    OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
6516   // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
6517   // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
6518   // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
6519   // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
6520   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
6521   VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
6522   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
6523     VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
6524 
6525   bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
6526   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
6527   SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
6528   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6529     CandidateTypes.push_back(BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(*this));
6530     CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
6531                                                  OpLoc,
6532                                                  true,
6533                                                  (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
6534                                                   Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
6535                                                   Op == OO_PipePipe),
6536                                                  VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
6537     HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
6538         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
6539     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
6540         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
6541         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
6542   }
6543 
6544   // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
6545   // for any of the arguments to the operator.
6546   //
6547   // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
6548   // 'bool' overloads.
6549   if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
6550       !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
6551     return;
6552 
6553   // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
6554   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args, NumArgs,
6555                                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
6556                                            HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
6557                                            CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
6558 
6559   // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
6560   switch (Op) {
6561   case OO_None:
6562   case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
6563     llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
6564 
6565   case OO_New:
6566   case OO_Delete:
6567   case OO_Array_New:
6568   case OO_Array_Delete:
6569   case OO_Call:
6570     llvm_unreachable(
6571                     "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
6572 
6573   case OO_Comma:
6574   case OO_Arrow:
6575     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6576     //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6577     //      operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
6578     break;
6579 
6580   case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
6581     if (NumArgs == 1)
6582       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
6583     // Fall through.
6584 
6585   case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
6586     if (NumArgs == 1) {
6587       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
6588     } else {
6589       OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
6590       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6591     }
6592     break;
6593 
6594   case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
6595     if (NumArgs == 1)
6596       OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
6597     else
6598       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6599     break;
6600 
6601   case OO_Slash:
6602     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6603     break;
6604 
6605   case OO_PlusPlus:
6606   case OO_MinusMinus:
6607     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6608     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
6609     break;
6610 
6611   case OO_EqualEqual:
6612   case OO_ExclaimEqual:
6613     OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOverloads();
6614     // Fall through.
6615 
6616   case OO_Less:
6617   case OO_Greater:
6618   case OO_LessEqual:
6619   case OO_GreaterEqual:
6620     OpBuilder.addRelationalPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
6621     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/true);
6622     break;
6623 
6624   case OO_Percent:
6625   case OO_Caret:
6626   case OO_Pipe:
6627   case OO_LessLess:
6628   case OO_GreaterGreater:
6629     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6630     break;
6631 
6632   case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
6633     if (NumArgs == 1)
6634       // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6635       //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
6636       //      operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
6637       break;
6638 
6639     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
6640     break;
6641 
6642   case OO_Tilde:
6643     OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
6644     break;
6645 
6646   case OO_Equal:
6647     OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
6648     // Fall through.
6649 
6650   case OO_PlusEqual:
6651   case OO_MinusEqual:
6652     OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
6653     // Fall through.
6654 
6655   case OO_StarEqual:
6656   case OO_SlashEqual:
6657     OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
6658     break;
6659 
6660   case OO_PercentEqual:
6661   case OO_LessLessEqual:
6662   case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
6663   case OO_AmpEqual:
6664   case OO_CaretEqual:
6665   case OO_PipeEqual:
6666     OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
6667     break;
6668 
6669   case OO_Exclaim:
6670     OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
6671     break;
6672 
6673   case OO_AmpAmp:
6674   case OO_PipePipe:
6675     OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
6676     break;
6677 
6678   case OO_Subscript:
6679     OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
6680     break;
6681 
6682   case OO_ArrowStar:
6683     OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
6684     break;
6685 
6686   case OO_Conditional:
6687     OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
6688     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads(/*isComparison=*/false);
6689     break;
6690   }
6691 }
6692 
6693 /// \brief Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
6694 /// to the set of overloading candidates.
6695 ///
6696 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
6697 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
6698 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
6699 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
6700 void
6701 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
6702                                            bool Operator,
6703                                            Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
6704                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6705                                            OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
6706                                            bool PartialOverloading,
6707                                            bool StdNamespaceIsAssociated) {
6708   ADLResult Fns;
6709 
6710   // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
6711   // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
6712   // which means we need to key off the canonical decl.  However,
6713   // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
6714   // right set of default arguments.  What default arguments are
6715   // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
6716 
6717   // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
6718   ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Operator, Args, NumArgs, Fns,
6719                           StdNamespaceIsAssociated);
6720 
6721   // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
6722   for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
6723                                    CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
6724        Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
6725     if (Cand->Function) {
6726       Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
6727       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
6728         Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
6729     }
6730 
6731   // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
6732   // set.
6733   for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6734     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
6735     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
6736       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
6737         continue;
6738 
6739       AddOverloadCandidate(FD, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
6740                            false, PartialOverloading);
6741     } else
6742       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I),
6743                                    FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6744                                    Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
6745   }
6746 }
6747 
6748 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
6749 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
6750 bool
6751 isBetterOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
6752                           const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
6753                           const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
6754                           SourceLocation Loc,
6755                           bool UserDefinedConversion) {
6756   // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
6757   // functions.
6758   if (!Cand2.Viable)
6759     return Cand1.Viable;
6760   else if (!Cand1.Viable)
6761     return false;
6762 
6763   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
6764   //
6765   //   -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
6766   //      that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
6767   //      any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
6768   //      better nor worse than ICS1(F).
6769   unsigned StartArg = 0;
6770   if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
6771     StartArg = 1;
6772 
6773   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
6774   //   A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
6775   //   viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
6776   //   conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
6777   unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
6778   assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
6779   bool HasBetterConversion = false;
6780   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
6781     switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
6782                                                Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
6783                                                Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
6784     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6785       // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6786       HasBetterConversion = true;
6787       break;
6788 
6789     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6790       // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6791       return false;
6792 
6793     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6794       // Do nothing.
6795       break;
6796     }
6797   }
6798 
6799   //    -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
6800   //       ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
6801   if (HasBetterConversion)
6802     return true;
6803 
6804   //     - F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
6805   //       specialization, or, if not that,
6806   if ((!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) &&
6807       Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
6808     return true;
6809 
6810   //   -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
6811   //      template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
6812   //      according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
6813   //      if not that,
6814   if (Cand1.Function && Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
6815       Cand2.Function && Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
6816     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate
6817           = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6818                                          Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
6819                                          Loc,
6820                        isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function)? TPOC_Conversion
6821                                                              : TPOC_Call,
6822                                          Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments))
6823       return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
6824   }
6825 
6826   //   -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
6827   //      (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
6828   //      from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
6829   //      the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
6830   //      conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
6831   //      from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
6832   if (UserDefinedConversion && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
6833       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
6834       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
6835     switch (CompareStandardConversionSequences(S,
6836                                                Cand1.FinalConversion,
6837                                                Cand2.FinalConversion)) {
6838     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
6839       // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
6840       return true;
6841 
6842     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
6843       // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
6844       return false;
6845 
6846     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
6847       // Do nothing
6848       break;
6849     }
6850   }
6851 
6852   return false;
6853 }
6854 
6855 /// \brief Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
6856 /// within an overload candidate set.
6857 ///
6858 /// \param CandidateSet the set of candidate functions.
6859 ///
6860 /// \param Loc the location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
6861 /// which overload resolution occurs.
6862 ///
6863 /// \param Best f overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
6864 /// function, Best points to the candidate function found.
6865 ///
6866 /// \returns The result of overload resolution.
6867 OverloadingResult
6868 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
6869                                          iterator &Best,
6870                                          bool UserDefinedConversion) {
6871   // Find the best viable function.
6872   Best = end();
6873   for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
6874     if (Cand->Viable)
6875       if (Best == end() || isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc,
6876                                                      UserDefinedConversion))
6877         Best = Cand;
6878   }
6879 
6880   // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
6881   if (Best == end())
6882     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
6883 
6884   // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
6885   // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
6886   for (iterator Cand = begin(); Cand != end(); ++Cand) {
6887     if (Cand->Viable &&
6888         Cand != Best &&
6889         !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Best, *Cand, Loc,
6890                                    UserDefinedConversion)) {
6891       Best = end();
6892       return OR_Ambiguous;
6893     }
6894   }
6895 
6896   // Best is the best viable function.
6897   if (Best->Function &&
6898       (Best->Function->isDeleted() ||
6899        S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Best->Function)))
6900     return OR_Deleted;
6901 
6902   return OR_Success;
6903 }
6904 
6905 namespace {
6906 
6907 enum OverloadCandidateKind {
6908   oc_function,
6909   oc_method,
6910   oc_constructor,
6911   oc_function_template,
6912   oc_method_template,
6913   oc_constructor_template,
6914   oc_implicit_default_constructor,
6915   oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
6916   oc_implicit_move_constructor,
6917   oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
6918   oc_implicit_move_assignment,
6919   oc_implicit_inherited_constructor
6920 };
6921 
6922 OverloadCandidateKind ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S,
6923                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn,
6924                                                 std::string &Description) {
6925   bool isTemplate = false;
6926 
6927   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
6928     isTemplate = true;
6929     Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
6930       FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
6931   }
6932 
6933   if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
6934     if (!Ctor->isImplicit())
6935       return isTemplate ? oc_constructor_template : oc_constructor;
6936 
6937     if (Ctor->getInheritedConstructor())
6938       return oc_implicit_inherited_constructor;
6939 
6940     if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
6941       return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
6942 
6943     if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
6944       return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
6945 
6946     assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
6947            "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
6948     return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
6949   }
6950 
6951   if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
6952     // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
6953     // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
6954     if (!Meth->isImplicit())
6955       return isTemplate ? oc_method_template : oc_method;
6956 
6957     if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
6958       return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
6959 
6960     assert(Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator()
6961            && "implicit method is not copy assignment operator?");
6962     return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
6963   }
6964 
6965   return isTemplate ? oc_function_template : oc_function;
6966 }
6967 
6968 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn) {
6969   const CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn);
6970   if (!Ctor) return;
6971 
6972   Ctor = Ctor->getInheritedConstructor();
6973   if (!Ctor) return;
6974 
6975   S.Diag(Ctor->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor);
6976 }
6977 
6978 } // end anonymous namespace
6979 
6980 // Notes the location of an overload candidate.
6981 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(FunctionDecl *Fn) {
6982   std::string FnDesc;
6983   OverloadCandidateKind K = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Fn, FnDesc);
6984   Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate)
6985     << (unsigned) K << FnDesc;
6986   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Fn);
6987 }
6988 
6989 //Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
6990 // OverloadedExpr
6991 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr* OverloadedExpr) {
6992   assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
6993 
6994   OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
6995   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
6996 
6997   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
6998                             IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
6999        I != IEnd; ++I) {
7000     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
7001                 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
7002       NoteOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl());
7003     } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
7004                       = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
7005       NoteOverloadCandidate(Fun);
7006     }
7007   }
7008 }
7009 
7010 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion.  The partial diagnostic is the
7011 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
7012 /// target types of the conversion.
7013 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
7014                                  Sema &S,
7015                                  SourceLocation CaretLoc,
7016                                  const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
7017   S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
7018     << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
7019   for (AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator
7020          I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7021     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I);
7022   }
7023 }
7024 
7025 namespace {
7026 
7027 void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand, unsigned I) {
7028   const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
7029   assert(Conv.isBad());
7030   assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
7031   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7032 
7033   // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
7034   // non-constructor method.  Note that 'I' corresponds the
7035   // conversion-slot index.
7036   bool isObjectArgument = false;
7037   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
7038     if (I == 0)
7039       isObjectArgument = true;
7040     else
7041       I--;
7042   }
7043 
7044   std::string FnDesc;
7045   OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
7046 
7047   Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
7048   QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
7049   QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
7050 
7051   if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
7052     assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
7053     Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
7054     if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
7055       E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
7056     DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
7057 
7058     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
7059       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7060       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7061       << ToTy << Name << I+1;
7062     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7063     return;
7064   }
7065 
7066   // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
7067   // to a qualifier mismatch.
7068   CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
7069   CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
7070   if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7071     CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
7072   else {
7073     // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
7074     if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7075       if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7076         CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType(), CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
7077   }
7078 
7079   if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
7080       !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
7081     // It is dumb that we have to do this here.
7082     while (isa<ArrayType>(CFromTy))
7083       CFromTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
7084     while (isa<ArrayType>(CToTy))
7085       CToTy = CFromTy->getAs<ArrayType>()->getElementType();
7086 
7087     Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
7088     Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
7089 
7090     if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
7091       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
7092         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7093         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7094         << FromTy
7095         << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
7096         << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7097       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7098       return;
7099     }
7100 
7101     if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
7102       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
7103         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7104         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7105         << FromTy
7106         << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
7107         << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7108       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7109       return;
7110     }
7111 
7112     if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
7113       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
7114       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7115       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7116       << FromTy
7117       << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
7118       << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7119       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7120       return;
7121     }
7122 
7123     unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
7124     assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
7125 
7126     if (isObjectArgument) {
7127       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
7128         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7129         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7130         << FromTy << (CVR - 1);
7131     } else {
7132       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
7133         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7134         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7135         << FromTy << (CVR - 1) << I+1;
7136     }
7137     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7138     return;
7139   }
7140 
7141   // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
7142   // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
7143   if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
7144     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
7145       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7146       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7147       << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7148     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7149     return;
7150   }
7151 
7152   // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
7153   // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
7154   // the failure.
7155   QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
7156   if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
7157     TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
7158   if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
7159     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
7160       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7161       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7162       << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7163     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7164     return;
7165   }
7166 
7167   // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
7168   unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
7169   if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7170     if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7171       if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
7172                                                FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
7173           !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
7174           !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
7175           S.IsDerivedFrom(ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
7176                           FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
7177         BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
7178     }
7179   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
7180                                     = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
7181     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
7182                                         = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
7183       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
7184         if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
7185           if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
7186                                                 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
7187               FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
7188             BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
7189   } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
7190       if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
7191           !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
7192           !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
7193           S.IsDerivedFrom(ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy))
7194         BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
7195     }
7196 
7197   if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
7198     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
7199            diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
7200       << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7201       << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7202       << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1)
7203       << FromTy << ToTy << I+1;
7204     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7205     return;
7206   }
7207 
7208   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
7209       isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
7210       Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
7211       Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
7212       if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
7213         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
7214         << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7215         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7216         << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I+1;
7217         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7218         return;
7219       }
7220   }
7221 
7222   // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
7223   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
7224   FDiag << (unsigned) FnKind << FnDesc
7225     << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
7226     << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned) isObjectArgument << I + 1
7227     << (unsigned) (Cand->Fix.Kind);
7228 
7229   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
7230   for (SmallVector<FixItHint, 1>::iterator
7231       HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(), HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end();
7232       HI != HE; ++HI)
7233     FDiag << *HI;
7234   S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
7235 
7236   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7237 }
7238 
7239 void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7240                            unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
7241   // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
7242 
7243   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7244   const FunctionProtoType *FnTy = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7245 
7246   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
7247 
7248   // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
7249   // have an arity mismatch when it fact it looks like we have the
7250   // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
7251   // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
7252   // Just don't report anything.
7253   if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
7254       Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
7255     return;
7256 
7257   // at least / at most / exactly
7258   unsigned mode, modeCount;
7259   if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
7260     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
7261            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
7262             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
7263     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs() ||
7264         FnTy->isVariadic() || FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
7265       mode = 0; // "at least"
7266     else
7267       mode = 2; // "exactly"
7268     modeCount = MinParams;
7269   } else {
7270     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
7271            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
7272             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
7273     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumArgs())
7274       mode = 1; // "at most"
7275     else
7276       mode = 2; // "exactly"
7277     modeCount = FnTy->getNumArgs();
7278   }
7279 
7280   std::string Description;
7281   OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, Description);
7282 
7283   S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
7284     << (unsigned) FnKind << (Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() != 0) << mode
7285     << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
7286   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7287 }
7288 
7289 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
7290 void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7291                           Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7292   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function; // pattern
7293 
7294   TemplateParameter Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
7295   NamedDecl *ParamD;
7296   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
7297   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
7298   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
7299   switch (Cand->DeductionFailure.Result) {
7300   case Sema::TDK_Success:
7301     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
7302 
7303   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
7304     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
7305     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
7306       << ParamD->getDeclName();
7307     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7308     return;
7309   }
7310 
7311   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
7312     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
7313     TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
7314 
7315     QualType Param = Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
7316 
7317     // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
7318     // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
7319     QualifierCollector Qs;
7320     Qs.strip(Param);
7321     QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
7322     assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
7323 
7324     // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
7325     // about that.  It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
7326     // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
7327     // done on dependent types).
7328     QualType Arg = Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
7329 
7330     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
7331       << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
7332     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7333     return;
7334   }
7335 
7336   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
7337     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
7338     int which = 0;
7339     if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
7340       which = 0;
7341     else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
7342       which = 1;
7343     else {
7344       which = 2;
7345     }
7346 
7347     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
7348       << which << ParamD->getDeclName()
7349       << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
7350       << *Cand->DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
7351     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7352     return;
7353   }
7354 
7355   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
7356     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
7357     if (ParamD->getDeclName())
7358       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
7359              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
7360         << ParamD->getDeclName();
7361     else {
7362       int index = 0;
7363       if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
7364         index = TTP->getIndex();
7365       else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
7366                                   = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
7367         index = NTTP->getIndex();
7368       else
7369         index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
7370       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
7371              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
7372         << (index + 1);
7373     }
7374     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7375     return;
7376 
7377   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
7378   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
7379     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
7380     return;
7381 
7382   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
7383     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
7384     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7385     return;
7386 
7387   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
7388     std::string ArgString;
7389     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args
7390                             = Cand->DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList())
7391       ArgString = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
7392                     Fn->getDescribedFunctionTemplate()->getTemplateParameters(),
7393                                                     *Args);
7394     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
7395       << ArgString;
7396     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7397     return;
7398   }
7399 
7400   // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
7401   // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
7402   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
7403   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
7404     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
7405     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7406     return;
7407   }
7408 }
7409 
7410 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
7411 void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7412   FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
7413   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
7414 
7415   Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
7416                            CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
7417 
7418   std::string FnDesc;
7419   OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Callee, FnDesc);
7420 
7421   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
7422       << (unsigned) FnKind << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
7423 }
7424 
7425 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate.  We've
7426 /// already generated a primary error at the call site.
7427 ///
7428 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
7429 /// pointed at the candidate declaration.  Yes, this creates some
7430 /// major challenges of technical writing.  Yes, this makes pointing
7431 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward.  It's still
7432 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
7433 /// overload.
7434 ///
7435 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
7436 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
7437 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
7438 void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7439                            Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7440   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
7441 
7442   // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
7443   if (Cand->Viable && (Fn->isDeleted() ||
7444       S.isFunctionConsideredUnavailable(Fn))) {
7445     std::string FnDesc;
7446     OverloadCandidateKind FnKind = ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Fn, FnDesc);
7447 
7448     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
7449       << FnKind << FnDesc << Fn->isDeleted();
7450     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Fn);
7451     return;
7452   }
7453 
7454   // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
7455   if (Cand->Viable) {
7456     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
7457     return;
7458   }
7459 
7460   switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
7461   case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
7462   case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
7463     return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
7464 
7465   case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
7466     return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
7467 
7468   case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
7469   case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
7470   case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
7471     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
7472 
7473   case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
7474     unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
7475     for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
7476       if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
7477         return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I);
7478 
7479     // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
7480     // when user-conversion overload fails.  Figure out how to handle
7481     // those conditions and diagnose them well.
7482     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Fn);
7483   }
7484 
7485   case ovl_fail_bad_target:
7486     return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
7487   }
7488 }
7489 
7490 void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7491   // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
7492   // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
7493   // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
7494   QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
7495   bool isLValueReference = false;
7496   bool isRValueReference = false;
7497   bool isPointer = false;
7498   if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
7499         FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
7500     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
7501     isLValueReference = true;
7502   } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
7503                FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
7504     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
7505     isRValueReference = true;
7506   }
7507   if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
7508     FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7509     isPointer = true;
7510   }
7511   // Desugar down to a function type.
7512   FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
7513   // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
7514   if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
7515   if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
7516   if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
7517 
7518   S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
7519     << FnType;
7520   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->Surrogate);
7521 }
7522 
7523 void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S,
7524                                   const char *Opc,
7525                                   SourceLocation OpLoc,
7526                                   OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7527   assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
7528   std::string TypeStr("operator");
7529   TypeStr += Opc;
7530   TypeStr += "(";
7531   TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0].getAsString();
7532   if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
7533     TypeStr += ")";
7534     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_unary_candidate) << TypeStr;
7535   } else {
7536     TypeStr += ", ";
7537     TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1].getAsString();
7538     TypeStr += ")";
7539     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_binary_candidate) << TypeStr;
7540   }
7541 }
7542 
7543 void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
7544                                   OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7545   unsigned NoOperands = Cand->Conversions.size();
7546   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NoOperands; ++ArgIdx) {
7547     const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS = Cand->Conversions[ArgIdx];
7548     if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
7549     if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
7550 
7551     ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(S, OpLoc,
7552                               S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
7553   }
7554 }
7555 
7556 SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
7557   if (Cand->Function)
7558     return Cand->Function->getLocation();
7559   if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
7560     return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
7561   return SourceLocation();
7562 }
7563 
7564 static unsigned
7565 RankDeductionFailure(const OverloadCandidate::DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
7566   switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
7567   case Sema::TDK_Success:
7568     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
7569 
7570   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
7571     return 1;
7572 
7573   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
7574   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
7575     return 2;
7576 
7577   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
7578   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
7579     return 3;
7580 
7581   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
7582   case Sema::TDK_FailedOverloadResolution:
7583     return 4;
7584 
7585   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
7586     return 5;
7587 
7588   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
7589   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
7590     return 6;
7591   }
7592   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
7593 }
7594 
7595 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
7596   Sema &S;
7597   CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
7598 
7599   bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
7600                   const OverloadCandidate *R) {
7601     // Fast-path this check.
7602     if (L == R) return false;
7603 
7604     // Order first by viability.
7605     if (L->Viable) {
7606       if (!R->Viable) return true;
7607 
7608       // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
7609       // candidates.  Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
7610       // that could exploit it.
7611       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation())) return true;
7612       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation())) return false;
7613     } else if (R->Viable)
7614       return false;
7615 
7616     assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
7617 
7618     // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
7619     if (!L->Viable) {
7620       // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
7621       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
7622           L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
7623         return false;
7624       if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
7625           R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
7626         return true;
7627 
7628       // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
7629       // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
7630       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
7631         if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
7632           return true;
7633 
7634         // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
7635         // comes first.
7636         unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
7637         unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
7638         numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
7639         numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
7640         if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
7641           if (numLFixes < numRFixes)
7642             return true;
7643           else
7644             return false;
7645         }
7646 
7647         // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
7648         // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
7649         assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
7650 
7651         int leftBetter = 0;
7652         unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
7653         for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
7654           switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S,
7655                                                      L->Conversions[I],
7656                                                      R->Conversions[I])) {
7657           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
7658             leftBetter++;
7659             break;
7660 
7661           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
7662             leftBetter--;
7663             break;
7664 
7665           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
7666             break;
7667           }
7668         }
7669         if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
7670         if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
7671 
7672       } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
7673         return false;
7674 
7675       if (L->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
7676         if (R->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
7677           return true;
7678 
7679         if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
7680           return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
7681                < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
7682       } else if (R->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
7683         return false;
7684 
7685       // TODO: others?
7686     }
7687 
7688     // Sort everything else by location.
7689     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
7690     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
7691 
7692     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
7693     if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
7694     if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
7695 
7696     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
7697   }
7698 };
7699 
7700 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
7701 /// computes up to the first. Produces the FixIt set if possible.
7702 void CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
7703                                 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
7704   assert(!Cand->Viable);
7705 
7706   // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
7707   if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion) return;
7708 
7709   // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
7710   bool Unfixable = false;
7711   // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
7712   Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
7713 
7714   // Skip forward to the first bad conversion.
7715   unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
7716   unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
7717   while (true) {
7718     assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
7719     ConvIdx++;
7720     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx - 1].isBad()) {
7721       Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx - 1, S);
7722       break;
7723     }
7724   }
7725 
7726   if (ConvIdx == ConvCount)
7727     return;
7728 
7729   assert(!Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
7730          "remaining conversion is initialized?");
7731 
7732   // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
7733   // operation somehow.
7734   bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
7735 
7736   const FunctionProtoType* Proto;
7737   unsigned ArgIdx = ConvIdx;
7738 
7739   if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
7740     QualType ConvType
7741       = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7742     if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
7743       ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
7744     Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7745     ArgIdx--;
7746   } else if (Cand->Function) {
7747     Proto = Cand->Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
7748     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
7749         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function))
7750       ArgIdx--;
7751   } else {
7752     // Builtin binary operator with a bad first conversion.
7753     assert(ConvCount <= 3);
7754     for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx)
7755       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
7756         = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ConvIdx],
7757                                 Cand->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[ConvIdx],
7758                                 SuppressUserConversions,
7759                                 /*InOverloadResolution*/ true,
7760                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7761                                   S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7762     return;
7763   }
7764 
7765   // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
7766   unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
7767   for (; ConvIdx != ConvCount; ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx) {
7768     if (ArgIdx < NumArgsInProto) {
7769       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx]
7770         = TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], Proto->getArgType(ArgIdx),
7771                                 SuppressUserConversions,
7772                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
7773                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7774                                   S.getLangOptions().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7775       // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
7776       if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
7777         Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
7778     }
7779     else
7780       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
7781   }
7782 }
7783 
7784 } // end anonymous namespace
7785 
7786 /// PrintOverloadCandidates - When overload resolution fails, prints
7787 /// diagnostic messages containing the candidates in the candidate
7788 /// set.
7789 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S,
7790                                           OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD,
7791                                           Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
7792                                           const char *Opc,
7793                                           SourceLocation OpLoc) {
7794   // Sort the candidates by viability and position.  Sorting directly would
7795   // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
7796   SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
7797   if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
7798   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
7799     if (Cand->Viable)
7800       Cands.push_back(Cand);
7801     else if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) {
7802       CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
7803       if (Cand->Function || Cand->IsSurrogate)
7804         Cands.push_back(Cand);
7805       // Otherwise, this a non-viable builtin candidate.  We do not, in general,
7806       // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
7807     }
7808   }
7809 
7810   std::sort(Cands.begin(), Cands.end(),
7811             CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S));
7812 
7813   bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
7814 
7815   SmallVectorImpl<OverloadCandidate*>::iterator I, E;
7816   const DiagnosticsEngine::OverloadsShown ShowOverloads =
7817       S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
7818   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
7819   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7820     OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
7821 
7822     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
7823     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
7824     // candidate list.
7825     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == DiagnosticsEngine::Ovl_Best) {
7826       break;
7827     }
7828     ++CandsShown;
7829 
7830     if (Cand->Function)
7831       NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args, NumArgs);
7832     else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
7833       NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
7834     else {
7835       assert(Cand->Viable &&
7836              "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
7837       // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
7838       // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
7839       // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
7840       //
7841       // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
7842       // different ambiguities, though.
7843       if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
7844         NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
7845         ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
7846       }
7847 
7848       // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
7849       NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
7850     }
7851   }
7852 
7853   if (I != E)
7854     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
7855 }
7856 
7857 // [PossiblyAFunctionType]  -->   [Return]
7858 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
7859 // R (A) --> R(A)
7860 // R (*)(A) --> R (A)
7861 // R (&)(A) --> R (A)
7862 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
7863 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
7864   QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
7865   if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
7866     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
7867     Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7868   else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
7869     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
7870     Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
7871   else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
7872     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
7873     Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
7874   Ret =
7875     Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
7876   return Ret;
7877 }
7878 
7879 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution
7880 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
7881 class AddressOfFunctionResolver
7882 {
7883   Sema& S;
7884   Expr* SourceExpr;
7885   const QualType& TargetType;
7886   QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
7887 
7888   bool Complain;
7889   //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
7890   ASTContext& Context;
7891 
7892   bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
7893   bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
7894 
7895   OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
7896   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
7897   TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
7898   SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
7899 
7900 public:
7901   AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr* SourceExpr,
7902                             const QualType& TargetType, bool Complain)
7903     : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
7904       Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
7905       TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
7906                                     !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
7907       FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
7908       OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
7909       OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression)
7910   {
7911     ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
7912 
7913     if (!TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
7914       if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
7915         DeclAccessPair dap;
7916         if (FunctionDecl* Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
7917                                             OvlExpr, false, &dap) ) {
7918 
7919           if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
7920             if (!Method->isStatic()) {
7921               // If the target type is a non-function type and the function
7922               // found is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was
7923               // the target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
7924               TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
7925 
7926               // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
7927               // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
7928               if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
7929                 return;
7930             }
7931           }
7932 
7933           Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap,Fn));
7934         }
7935       }
7936       return;
7937     }
7938 
7939     if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
7940       OvlExpr->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
7941 
7942     if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
7943       // C++ [over.over]p4:
7944       //   If more than one function is selected, [...]
7945       if (Matches.size() > 1) {
7946         if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
7947           EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
7948         else
7949           EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
7950       }
7951     }
7952   }
7953 
7954 private:
7955   bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
7956     return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
7957   }
7958 
7959   // [ToType]     [Return]
7960 
7961   // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7962   // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
7963   // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
7964   void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
7965     TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
7966   }
7967 
7968   // return true if any matching specializations were found
7969   bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
7970                                    const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
7971     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
7972               = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
7973       // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
7974       // static when converting to member pointer.
7975       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7976         return false;
7977     }
7978     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
7979       return false;
7980 
7981     // C++ [over.over]p2:
7982     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
7983     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
7984     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
7985     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
7986     //   overloaded functions considered.
7987     FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
7988     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, OvlExpr->getNameLoc());
7989     if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
7990           = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
7991                                       &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
7992                                       TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
7993                                       Info)) {
7994       // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
7995       (void)Result;
7996       return false;
7997     }
7998 
7999     // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match.
8000     // This function template specicalization works.
8001     Specialization = cast<FunctionDecl>(Specialization->getCanonicalDecl());
8002     assert(TargetFunctionType
8003                       == Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()));
8004     Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
8005     return true;
8006   }
8007 
8008   bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
8009                                       const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
8010     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
8011       // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
8012       // when converting to member pointer.
8013       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8014         return false;
8015     }
8016     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
8017       return false;
8018 
8019     if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
8020       if (S.getLangOptions().CUDA)
8021         if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
8022           if (S.CheckCUDATarget(Caller, FunDecl))
8023             return false;
8024 
8025       QualType ResultTy;
8026       if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType,
8027                                          FunDecl->getType()) ||
8028           S.IsNoReturnConversion(FunDecl->getType(), TargetFunctionType,
8029                                  ResultTy)) {
8030         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair,
8031           cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
8032         FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
8033         return true;
8034       }
8035     }
8036 
8037     return false;
8038   }
8039 
8040   bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
8041     bool Ret = false;
8042 
8043     // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
8044     // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
8045     if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
8046       return false;
8047 
8048     for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
8049                                E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
8050          I != E; ++I) {
8051       // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
8052       NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
8053 
8054       // C++ [over.over]p3:
8055       //   Non-member functions and static member functions match
8056       //   targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
8057       //   Nonstatic member functions match targets of
8058       //   type "pointer-to-member-function."
8059       // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
8060       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
8061                                         = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
8062         if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
8063           Ret = true;
8064       }
8065       // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
8066       else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
8067                AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
8068         Ret = true;
8069     }
8070     assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
8071     return Ret;
8072   }
8073 
8074   void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
8075     //   [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
8076     //   eliminated if the set contains a second function template
8077     //   specialization whose function template is more specialized
8078     //   than the function template of F1 according to the partial
8079     //   ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
8080 
8081     // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
8082     // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
8083     // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
8084     // best function template (if it exists).
8085 
8086     UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
8087     for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
8088       MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
8089 
8090     UnresolvedSetIterator Result =
8091       S.getMostSpecialized(MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(),
8092                            TPOC_Other, 0, SourceExpr->getLocStart(),
8093                            S.PDiag(),
8094                            S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8095                              << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
8096                            S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
8097                              << (unsigned) oc_function_template,
8098                            Complain);
8099 
8100     if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
8101       // Make it the first and only element
8102       Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
8103       Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
8104       Matches.resize(1);
8105     }
8106   }
8107 
8108   void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
8109     //   [...] any function template specializations in the set are
8110     //   eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
8111     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
8112       if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == 0)
8113         ++I;
8114       else {
8115         Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
8116         Matches.set_size(N);
8117       }
8118     }
8119   }
8120 
8121 public:
8122   void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
8123     assert(Matches.empty());
8124     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
8125         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
8126         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
8127     S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
8128   }
8129 
8130   bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
8131     return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
8132       !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
8133   }
8134 
8135   void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
8136       // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
8137       // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
8138       // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
8139       S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
8140         << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
8141   }
8142 
8143   void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
8144     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
8145       << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
8146   }
8147 
8148   void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
8149     assert(Matches.size() > 1);
8150     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8151       << OvlExpr->getName()
8152       << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
8153     S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr);
8154   }
8155 
8156   int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
8157 
8158   FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
8159     if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
8160     return Matches[0].second;
8161   }
8162 
8163   const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
8164     if (Matches.size() != 1) return 0;
8165     return &Matches[0].first;
8166   }
8167 };
8168 
8169 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
8170 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
8171 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
8172 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
8173 ///
8174 /// @code
8175 /// int f(double);
8176 /// int f(int);
8177 ///
8178 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
8179 /// @endcode
8180 ///
8181 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
8182 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
8183 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
8184 FunctionDecl *
8185 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr, QualType TargetType,
8186                                     bool Complain,
8187                                     DeclAccessPair &FoundResult) {
8188 
8189   assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8190 
8191   AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType, Complain);
8192   int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
8193   FunctionDecl* Fn = 0;
8194   if ( NumMatches == 0 && Complain) {
8195     if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
8196       Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
8197     else
8198       Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
8199   }
8200   else if (NumMatches > 1 && Complain)
8201     Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
8202   else if (NumMatches == 1) {
8203     Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
8204     assert(Fn);
8205     FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
8206     MarkDeclarationReferenced(AddressOfExpr->getLocStart(), Fn);
8207     if (Complain)
8208       CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
8209   }
8210 
8211   return Fn;
8212 }
8213 
8214 /// \brief Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
8215 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
8216 ///
8217 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
8218 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
8219 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
8220 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
8221 FunctionDecl *
8222 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
8223                                                   bool Complain,
8224                                                   DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
8225   // C++ [over.over]p1:
8226   //   [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
8227   //   overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
8228   // C++ [over.over]p1:
8229   //   [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
8230   //   operator.
8231 
8232   // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
8233   if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
8234     return 0;
8235 
8236   TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
8237   ovl->getExplicitTemplateArgs().copyInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
8238 
8239   // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
8240   // whose type matches exactly.
8241   FunctionDecl *Matched = 0;
8242   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
8243          E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
8244     // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
8245     //   [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
8246     //   where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
8247     //   specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
8248     //   identifies a single function template specialization, then the
8249     //   template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
8250     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
8251       = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
8252 
8253     // C++ [over.over]p2:
8254     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
8255     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
8256     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
8257     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
8258     //   overloaded functions considered.
8259     FunctionDecl *Specialization = 0;
8260     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(Context, ovl->getNameLoc());
8261     if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
8262           = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8263                                     Specialization, Info)) {
8264       // FIXME: make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
8265       (void)Result;
8266       continue;
8267     }
8268 
8269     assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
8270 
8271     // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
8272     if (Matched) {
8273       if (Complain) {
8274         Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
8275           << ovl->getName();
8276         NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
8277       }
8278       return 0;
8279     }
8280 
8281     Matched = Specialization;
8282     if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
8283   }
8284 
8285   return Matched;
8286 }
8287 
8288 
8289 
8290 
8291 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
8292 // because it identifies a single function template specialization.
8293 //
8294 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
8295 //
8296 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
8297 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded.  Always
8298 // returns true if 'complain' is set.
8299 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
8300                       ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
8301                    bool complain, const SourceRange& OpRangeForComplaining,
8302                                            QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
8303                                             unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
8304   assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
8305 
8306   OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
8307 
8308   DeclAccessPair found;
8309   ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
8310   if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
8311                            ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
8312     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin())) {
8313       SrcExpr = ExprError();
8314       return true;
8315     }
8316 
8317     // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
8318     // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
8319     // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
8320     // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
8321     if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
8322         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
8323         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
8324       if (!complain) return false;
8325 
8326       Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
8327            diag::err_bound_member_function)
8328         << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
8329 
8330       // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
8331       // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
8332       // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
8333       // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
8334       // the static candidates were rejected.
8335       SrcExpr = ExprError();
8336       return true;
8337     }
8338 
8339     // Fix the expresion to refer to 'fn'.
8340     SingleFunctionExpression =
8341       Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.take(), found, fn));
8342 
8343     // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
8344     if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
8345       SingleFunctionExpression =
8346         DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.take());
8347       if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
8348         SrcExpr = ExprError();
8349         return true;
8350       }
8351     }
8352   }
8353 
8354   if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
8355     if (complain) {
8356       Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
8357         << ovl.Expression->getName()
8358         << DestTypeForComplaining
8359         << OpRangeForComplaining
8360         << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
8361       NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
8362 
8363       SrcExpr = ExprError();
8364       return true;
8365     }
8366 
8367     return false;
8368   }
8369 
8370   SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
8371   return true;
8372 }
8373 
8374 /// \brief Add a single candidate to the overload set.
8375 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
8376                                        DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
8377                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8378                                        Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8379                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
8380                                        bool PartialOverloading,
8381                                        bool KnownValid) {
8382   NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
8383   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
8384     Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
8385 
8386   if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
8387     if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
8388       assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
8389       return;
8390     }
8391     S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
8392                            false, PartialOverloading);
8393     return;
8394   }
8395 
8396   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
8397       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
8398     S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
8399                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8400                                    Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
8401     return;
8402   }
8403 
8404   assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
8405 }
8406 
8407 /// \brief Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
8408 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
8409 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
8410                                        Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8411                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
8412                                        bool PartialOverloading) {
8413 
8414 #ifndef NDEBUG
8415   // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
8416   // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
8417   //
8418   //   Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
8419   //   and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
8420   //   lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
8421   //
8422   //     -- a declaration of a class member, or
8423   //
8424   //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
8425   //        using-declaration, or
8426   //
8427   //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
8428   //        template
8429   //
8430   //   then Y is empty.
8431 
8432   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
8433     for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
8434            E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
8435       assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
8436       assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
8437              !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
8438       assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
8439     }
8440   }
8441 #endif
8442 
8443   // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
8444   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
8445   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
8446   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8447     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
8448     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
8449   }
8450 
8451   for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
8452          E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
8453     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8454                                Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
8455                                PartialOverloading, /*KnownValid*/ true);
8456 
8457   if (ULE->requiresADL())
8458     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), /*Operator*/ false,
8459                                          Args, NumArgs,
8460                                          ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8461                                          CandidateSet,
8462                                          PartialOverloading,
8463                                          ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace());
8464 }
8465 
8466 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
8467 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
8468 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
8469 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
8470 ///
8471 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
8472 static bool
8473 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
8474                        const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
8475                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
8476                        Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
8477   if (SemaRef.ActiveTemplateInstantiations.empty() || !SS.isEmpty())
8478     return false;
8479 
8480   for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
8481     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
8482 
8483     if (!R.empty()) {
8484       R.suppressDiagnostics();
8485 
8486       if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
8487         // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
8488         // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
8489         R.clear();
8490         return false;
8491       }
8492 
8493       OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc);
8494       for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
8495         AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
8496                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs,
8497                                    Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
8498 
8499       OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
8500       if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
8501         // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
8502         // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
8503         R.clear();
8504         return false;
8505       }
8506 
8507       // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
8508       // declaring the function there instead.
8509       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
8510       Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
8511       SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(Args, NumArgs,
8512                                                  AssociatedNamespaces,
8513                                                  AssociatedClasses);
8514       // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
8515       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
8516       if (DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace()) {
8517         for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
8518                it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
8519                end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
8520           if (!Std->Encloses(*it))
8521             SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
8522         }
8523       } else {
8524         // Lacking the 'std::' namespace, use all of the associated namespaces.
8525         SuggestedNamespaces = AssociatedNamespaces;
8526       }
8527 
8528       SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
8529         << R.getLookupName();
8530       if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
8531         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
8532                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
8533           << R.getLookupName() << 0;
8534       } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
8535         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
8536                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
8537           << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
8538       } else {
8539         // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
8540         // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
8541         // a localized representation of a list of items.
8542         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
8543                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
8544           << R.getLookupName() << 2;
8545       }
8546 
8547       // Try to recover by calling this function.
8548       return true;
8549     }
8550 
8551     R.clear();
8552   }
8553 
8554   return false;
8555 }
8556 
8557 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
8558 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
8559 /// was defined.
8560 ///
8561 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
8562 static bool
8563 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
8564                                SourceLocation OpLoc,
8565                                Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
8566   DeclarationName OpName =
8567     SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8568   LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
8569   return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
8570                                 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/0, Args, NumArgs);
8571 }
8572 
8573 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
8574 ///
8575 /// Returns true if new candidates were found.
8576 static ExprResult
8577 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
8578                       UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
8579                       SourceLocation LParenLoc,
8580                       Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8581                       SourceLocation RParenLoc,
8582                       bool EmptyLookup) {
8583 
8584   CXXScopeSpec SS;
8585   SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
8586 
8587   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
8588   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = 0;
8589   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
8590     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
8591     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
8592   }
8593 
8594   LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
8595                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
8596   if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R,
8597                               ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs) &&
8598       (!EmptyLookup ||
8599        SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Sema::CTC_Expression,
8600                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, NumArgs)))
8601     return ExprError();
8602 
8603   assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
8604 
8605   // Build an implicit member call if appropriate.  Just drop the
8606   // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
8607   ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
8608   if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
8609     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R,
8610                                                     ExplicitTemplateArgs);
8611   else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
8612     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *ExplicitTemplateArgs);
8613   else
8614     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
8615 
8616   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
8617     return ExprError();
8618 
8619   // This shouldn't cause an infinite loop because we're giving it
8620   // an expression with viable lookup results, which should never
8621   // end up here.
8622   return SemaRef.ActOnCallExpr(/*Scope*/ 0, NewFn.take(), LParenLoc,
8623                                MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs), RParenLoc);
8624 }
8625 
8626 /// ResolveOverloadedCallFn - Given the call expression that calls Fn
8627 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
8628 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
8629 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
8630 /// the function declaration produced by overload
8631 /// resolution. Otherwise, emits diagnostics, deletes all of the
8632 /// arguments and Fn, and returns NULL.
8633 ExprResult
8634 Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
8635                               SourceLocation LParenLoc,
8636                               Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
8637                               SourceLocation RParenLoc,
8638                               Expr *ExecConfig) {
8639 #ifndef NDEBUG
8640   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
8641     // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
8642     assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
8643 
8644     // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
8645     // Verify that this was correctly set up.
8646     FunctionDecl *F;
8647     if (ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
8648         (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
8649         F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
8650       llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
8651 
8652     // We don't perform ADL in C.
8653     assert(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
8654   } else
8655     assert(!ULE->isStdAssociatedNamespace() &&
8656            "std is associated namespace but not doing ADL");
8657 #endif
8658 
8659   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
8660   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
8661     return ExprError();
8662 
8663   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc());
8664 
8665   // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
8666   // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
8667   AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
8668 
8669   // If we found nothing, try to recover.
8670   // BuildRecoveryCallExpr diagnoses the error itself, so we just bail
8671   // out if it fails.
8672   if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
8673     // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function then
8674     // create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name lookup
8675     // to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent base
8676     // classes.
8677     if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && CurContext->isDependentContext() &&
8678         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
8679       CallExpr *CE = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
8680                                           Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
8681                                           RParenLoc);
8682       CE->setTypeDependent(true);
8683       return Owned(CE);
8684     }
8685     return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
8686                                  RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true);
8687   }
8688 
8689   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
8690 
8691   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
8692   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getLocStart(), Best)) {
8693   case OR_Success: {
8694     FunctionDecl *FDecl = Best->Function;
8695     MarkDeclarationReferenced(Fn->getExprLoc(), FDecl);
8696     CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, Best->FoundDecl);
8697     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc());
8698     Fn = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, Best->FoundDecl, FDecl);
8699     return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
8700                                  ExecConfig);
8701   }
8702 
8703   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
8704     // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
8705     // have meant to call.
8706     ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
8707                                                 Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc,
8708                                                 /*EmptyLookup=*/false);
8709     if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
8710       return Recovery;
8711 
8712     Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
8713          diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
8714       << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
8715     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
8716     break;
8717   }
8718 
8719   case OR_Ambiguous:
8720     Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
8721       << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange();
8722     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
8723     break;
8724 
8725   case OR_Deleted:
8726     {
8727       Diag(Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
8728         << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8729         << ULE->getName()
8730         << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
8731         << Fn->getSourceRange();
8732       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
8733     }
8734     break;
8735   }
8736 
8737   // Overload resolution failed.
8738   return ExprError();
8739 }
8740 
8741 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
8742   return Functions.size() > 1 ||
8743     (Functions.size() == 1 && isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*Functions.begin()));
8744 }
8745 
8746 /// \brief Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
8747 /// operator.
8748 ///
8749 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
8750 ///
8751 /// \param OpcIn The UnaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
8752 /// operator.
8753 ///
8754 /// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
8755 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
8756 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
8757 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
8758 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
8759 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
8760 ///
8761 /// \param input The input argument.
8762 ExprResult
8763 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, unsigned OpcIn,
8764                               const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
8765                               Expr *Input) {
8766   UnaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
8767 
8768   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8769   assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
8770   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8771   // TODO: provide better source location info.
8772   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
8773 
8774   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
8775     return ExprError();
8776 
8777   Expr *Args[2] = { Input, 0 };
8778   unsigned NumArgs = 1;
8779 
8780   // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
8781   // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
8782   // post-decrement.
8783   if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
8784     llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
8785     Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
8786                                      SourceLocation());
8787     NumArgs = 2;
8788   }
8789 
8790   if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
8791     if (Fns.empty())
8792       return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input,
8793                                                Opc,
8794                                                Context.DependentTy,
8795                                                VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
8796                                                OpLoc));
8797 
8798     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
8799     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
8800       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
8801                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
8802                                      /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
8803                                      Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
8804     return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
8805                                                   &Args[0], NumArgs,
8806                                                    Context.DependentTy,
8807                                                    VK_RValue,
8808                                                    OpLoc));
8809   }
8810 
8811   // Build an empty overload set.
8812   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
8813 
8814   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
8815   AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet, false);
8816 
8817   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
8818   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
8819 
8820   // Add candidates from ADL.
8821   AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
8822                                        Args, NumArgs,
8823                                        /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
8824                                        CandidateSet);
8825 
8826   // Add builtin operator candidates.
8827   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, &Args[0], NumArgs, CandidateSet);
8828 
8829   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
8830 
8831   // Perform overload resolution.
8832   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
8833   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
8834   case OR_Success: {
8835     // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
8836     FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
8837 
8838     if (FnDecl) {
8839       // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
8840       // operator.
8841 
8842       MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
8843 
8844       // Convert the arguments.
8845       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
8846         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], 0, Best->FoundDecl);
8847 
8848         ExprResult InputRes =
8849           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/0,
8850                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
8851         if (InputRes.isInvalid())
8852           return ExprError();
8853         Input = InputRes.take();
8854       } else {
8855         // Convert the arguments.
8856         ExprResult InputInit
8857           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
8858                                                       Context,
8859                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
8860                                       SourceLocation(),
8861                                       Input);
8862         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
8863           return ExprError();
8864         Input = InputInit.take();
8865       }
8866 
8867       DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
8868 
8869       // Determine the result type.
8870       QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
8871       ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
8872       ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8873 
8874       // Build the actual expression node.
8875       ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
8876                                                 HadMultipleCandidates);
8877       if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
8878         return ExprError();
8879 
8880       Args[0] = Input;
8881       CallExpr *TheCall =
8882         new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
8883                                           Args, NumArgs, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
8884 
8885       if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
8886                               FnDecl))
8887         return ExprError();
8888 
8889       return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
8890     } else {
8891       // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
8892       // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
8893       // operator node.
8894       ExprResult InputRes =
8895         PerformImplicitConversion(Input, Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
8896                                   Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
8897       if (InputRes.isInvalid())
8898         return ExprError();
8899       Input = InputRes.take();
8900       break;
8901     }
8902   }
8903 
8904   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
8905     // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
8906     // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
8907     // defined too late to be candidates.
8908     if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args, NumArgs))
8909       // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
8910       return ExprError();
8911 
8912     // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
8913     // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
8914     break;
8915 
8916   case OR_Ambiguous:
8917     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
8918         << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8919         << Input->getType()
8920         << Input->getSourceRange();
8921     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs,
8922                                 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
8923     return ExprError();
8924 
8925   case OR_Deleted:
8926     Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
8927       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
8928       << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
8929       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
8930       << Input->getSourceRange();
8931     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs,
8932                                 UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
8933     return ExprError();
8934   }
8935 
8936   // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
8937   // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
8938   // build a built-in operation.
8939   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
8940 }
8941 
8942 /// \brief Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
8943 /// operator.
8944 ///
8945 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
8946 ///
8947 /// \param OpcIn The BinaryOperator::Opcode that describes this
8948 /// operator.
8949 ///
8950 /// \param Functions The set of non-member functions that will be
8951 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
8952 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
8953 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
8954 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
8955 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
8956 ///
8957 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
8958 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
8959 ExprResult
8960 Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
8961                             unsigned OpcIn,
8962                             const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
8963                             Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS) {
8964   Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
8965   LHS=RHS=0; //Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
8966 
8967   BinaryOperator::Opcode Opc = static_cast<BinaryOperator::Opcode>(OpcIn);
8968   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
8969   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
8970 
8971   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
8972   // expression.
8973   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
8974     if (Fns.empty()) {
8975       // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
8976       // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
8977       if (Opc <= BO_Assign || Opc > BO_OrAssign)
8978         return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
8979                                                   Context.DependentTy,
8980                                                   VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
8981                                                   OpLoc));
8982 
8983       return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
8984                                                         Context.DependentTy,
8985                                                         VK_LValue,
8986                                                         OK_Ordinary,
8987                                                         Context.DependentTy,
8988                                                         Context.DependentTy,
8989                                                         OpLoc));
8990     }
8991 
8992     // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
8993     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
8994     // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
8995     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
8996     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
8997       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
8998                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
8999                                      /*ADL*/ true, IsOverloaded(Fns),
9000                                      Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
9001     return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, Fn,
9002                                                    Args, 2,
9003                                                    Context.DependentTy,
9004                                                    VK_RValue,
9005                                                    OpLoc));
9006   }
9007 
9008   // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
9009   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
9010     return ExprError();
9011 
9012   // The LHS is more complicated.
9013   if (Args[0]->getObjectKind() == OK_ObjCProperty) {
9014 
9015     // There's a tension for assignment operators between primitive
9016     // property assignment and the overloaded operators.
9017     if (BinaryOperator::isAssignmentOp(Opc)) {
9018       const ObjCPropertyRefExpr *PRE = LHS->getObjCProperty();
9019 
9020       // Is the property "logically" settable?
9021       bool Settable = (PRE->isExplicitProperty() ||
9022                        PRE->getImplicitPropertySetter());
9023 
9024       // To avoid gratuitously inventing semantics, use the primitive
9025       // unless it isn't.  Thoughts in case we ever really care:
9026       // - If the property isn't logically settable, we have to
9027       //   load and hope.
9028       // - If the property is settable and this is simple assignment,
9029       //   we really should use the primitive.
9030       // - If the property is settable, then we could try overloading
9031       //   on a generic lvalue of the appropriate type;  if it works
9032       //   out to a builtin candidate, we would do that same operation
9033       //   on the property, and otherwise just error.
9034       if (Settable)
9035         return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
9036     }
9037 
9038     ExprResult Result = ConvertPropertyForRValue(Args[0]);
9039     if (Result.isInvalid())
9040       return ExprError();
9041     Args[0] = Result.take();
9042   }
9043 
9044   // Handle all the other placeholders.
9045   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
9046     return ExprError();
9047 
9048   // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
9049   // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
9050   // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
9051   // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
9052   // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
9053   // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
9054   if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
9055     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
9056 
9057   // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
9058   // create a built-in binary operator.
9059   if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
9060     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
9061 
9062   // Build an empty overload set.
9063   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc);
9064 
9065   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
9066   AddFunctionCandidates(Fns, Args, 2, CandidateSet, false);
9067 
9068   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9069   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9070 
9071   // Add candidates from ADL.
9072   AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, /*Operator*/ true,
9073                                        Args, 2,
9074                                        /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ 0,
9075                                        CandidateSet);
9076 
9077   // Add builtin operator candidates.
9078   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9079 
9080   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9081 
9082   // Perform overload resolution.
9083   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
9084   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
9085     case OR_Success: {
9086       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
9087       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
9088 
9089       if (FnDecl) {
9090         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9091         // operator.
9092 
9093         MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, FnDecl);
9094 
9095         // Convert the arguments.
9096         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
9097           // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
9098           CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
9099 
9100           ExprResult Arg1 =
9101             PerformCopyInitialization(
9102               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9103                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
9104               SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
9105           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
9106             return ExprError();
9107 
9108           ExprResult Arg0 =
9109             PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
9110                                                 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9111           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
9112             return ExprError();
9113           Args[0] = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
9114           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
9115         } else {
9116           // Convert the arguments.
9117           ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
9118             InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9119                                                    FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
9120             SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[0]));
9121           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
9122             return ExprError();
9123 
9124           ExprResult Arg1 =
9125             PerformCopyInitialization(
9126               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
9127                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
9128               SourceLocation(), Owned(Args[1]));
9129           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
9130             return ExprError();
9131           Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.takeAs<Expr>();
9132           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.takeAs<Expr>();
9133         }
9134 
9135         DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
9136 
9137         // Determine the result type.
9138         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9139         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9140         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
9141 
9142         // Build the actual expression node.
9143         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
9144                                                   HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
9145         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9146           return ExprError();
9147 
9148         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
9149           new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, Op, FnExpr.take(),
9150                                             Args, 2, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
9151 
9152         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
9153                                 FnDecl))
9154           return ExprError();
9155 
9156         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
9157       } else {
9158         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
9159         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
9160         // operator node.
9161         ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
9162           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
9163                                     Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
9164         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
9165           return ExprError();
9166         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
9167 
9168         ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
9169           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
9170                                     Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
9171         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
9172           return ExprError();
9173         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
9174         break;
9175       }
9176     }
9177 
9178     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9179       // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
9180       //   If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
9181       //   viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
9182       //   built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
9183       if (Opc == BO_Comma)
9184         break;
9185 
9186       // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assigment
9187       // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
9188       // no overloaded assignment operator found
9189       ExprResult Result = ExprError();
9190       if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
9191           Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
9192         Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
9193              << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
9194              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
9195       } else {
9196         // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
9197         // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
9198         // defined too late to be candidates.
9199         if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args, 2))
9200           // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
9201           return ExprError();
9202 
9203         // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
9204         // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
9205         Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
9206       }
9207       assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
9208              "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
9209       if (Result.isInvalid())
9210         CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
9211                                     BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
9212       return move(Result);
9213     }
9214 
9215     case OR_Ambiguous:
9216       Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
9217           << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
9218           << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
9219           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
9220       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
9221                                   BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
9222       return ExprError();
9223 
9224     case OR_Deleted:
9225       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9226         << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9227         << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
9228         << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
9229         << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
9230       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
9231                                   BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
9232       return ExprError();
9233   }
9234 
9235   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
9236   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
9237 }
9238 
9239 ExprResult
9240 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
9241                                          SourceLocation RLoc,
9242                                          Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
9243   Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
9244   DeclarationName OpName =
9245       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
9246 
9247   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
9248   // expression.
9249   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
9250 
9251     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = 0; // because lookup ignores member operators
9252     // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
9253     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
9254     OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
9255     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn
9256       = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass,
9257                                      NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo,
9258                                      /*ADL*/ true, /*Overloaded*/ false,
9259                                      UnresolvedSetIterator(),
9260                                      UnresolvedSetIterator());
9261     // Can't add any actual overloads yet
9262 
9263     return Owned(new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn,
9264                                                    Args, 2,
9265                                                    Context.DependentTy,
9266                                                    VK_RValue,
9267                                                    RLoc));
9268   }
9269 
9270   // Handle placeholders on both operands.
9271   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
9272     return ExprError();
9273   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
9274     return ExprError();
9275 
9276   // Build an empty overload set.
9277   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc);
9278 
9279   // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
9280 
9281   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
9282   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9283 
9284   // Add builtin operator candidates.
9285   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, 2, CandidateSet);
9286 
9287   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9288 
9289   // Perform overload resolution.
9290   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
9291   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
9292     case OR_Success: {
9293       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
9294       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
9295 
9296       if (FnDecl) {
9297         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
9298         // operator.
9299 
9300         MarkDeclarationReferenced(LLoc, FnDecl);
9301 
9302         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
9303         DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LLoc);
9304 
9305         // Convert the arguments.
9306         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
9307         ExprResult Arg0 =
9308           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/0,
9309                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9310         if (Arg0.isInvalid())
9311           return ExprError();
9312         Args[0] = Arg0.take();
9313 
9314         // Convert the arguments.
9315         ExprResult InputInit
9316           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
9317                                                       Context,
9318                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
9319                                       SourceLocation(),
9320                                       Owned(Args[1]));
9321         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
9322           return ExprError();
9323 
9324         Args[1] = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
9325 
9326         // Determine the result type
9327         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getResultType();
9328         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9329         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
9330 
9331         // Build the actual expression node.
9332         DeclarationNameLoc LocInfo;
9333         LocInfo.CXXOperatorName.BeginOpNameLoc = LLoc.getRawEncoding();
9334         LocInfo.CXXOperatorName.EndOpNameLoc = RLoc.getRawEncoding();
9335         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
9336                                                   HadMultipleCandidates,
9337                                                   LLoc, LocInfo);
9338         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
9339           return ExprError();
9340 
9341         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
9342           new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Subscript,
9343                                             FnExpr.take(), Args, 2,
9344                                             ResultTy, VK, RLoc);
9345 
9346         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getResultType(), LLoc, TheCall,
9347                                 FnDecl))
9348           return ExprError();
9349 
9350         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
9351       } else {
9352         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
9353         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
9354         // operator node.
9355         ExprResult ArgsRes0 =
9356           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[0], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[0],
9357                                     Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing);
9358         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
9359           return ExprError();
9360         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.take();
9361 
9362         ExprResult ArgsRes1 =
9363           PerformImplicitConversion(Args[1], Best->BuiltinTypes.ParamTypes[1],
9364                                     Best->Conversions[1], AA_Passing);
9365         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
9366           return ExprError();
9367         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.take();
9368 
9369         break;
9370       }
9371     }
9372 
9373     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
9374       if (CandidateSet.empty())
9375         Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
9376           << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
9377           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
9378       else
9379         Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
9380           << Args[0]->getType()
9381           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
9382       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
9383                                   "[]", LLoc);
9384       return ExprError();
9385     }
9386 
9387     case OR_Ambiguous:
9388       Diag(LLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
9389           << "[]"
9390           << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType()
9391           << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
9392       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, 2,
9393                                   "[]", LLoc);
9394       return ExprError();
9395 
9396     case OR_Deleted:
9397       Diag(LLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9398         << Best->Function->isDeleted() << "[]"
9399         << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
9400         << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
9401       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, 2,
9402                                   "[]", LLoc);
9403       return ExprError();
9404     }
9405 
9406   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
9407   return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
9408 }
9409 
9410 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
9411 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
9412 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
9413 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object
9414 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
9415 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
9416 /// member function.
9417 ExprResult
9418 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
9419                                 SourceLocation LParenLoc, Expr **Args,
9420                                 unsigned NumArgs, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
9421   assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
9422          MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
9423 
9424   // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
9425   // argument and the member function we're referring to.
9426   Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
9427 
9428   // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
9429   if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
9430     assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
9431     assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
9432 
9433     QualType fnType =
9434       op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9435 
9436     const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9437     QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
9438     ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getResultType());
9439 
9440     // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
9441     // member function we're calling.
9442     Qualifiers funcQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(proto->getTypeQuals());
9443 
9444     QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
9445     if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
9446       objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
9447     Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
9448 
9449     Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
9450     difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
9451     difference.removeAddressSpace();
9452     if (difference) {
9453       std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
9454       Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
9455         << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
9456         << qualsString
9457         << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
9458     }
9459 
9460     CXXMemberCallExpr *call
9461       = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
9462                                         resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc);
9463 
9464     if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getResultType(),
9465                             op->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
9466                             call, 0))
9467       return ExprError();
9468 
9469     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, 0, proto, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc))
9470       return ExprError();
9471 
9472     return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
9473   }
9474 
9475   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
9476   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
9477     return ExprError();
9478 
9479   MemberExpr *MemExpr;
9480   CXXMethodDecl *Method = 0;
9481   DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(0, AS_public);
9482   NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
9483   if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
9484     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
9485     Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
9486     FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
9487     Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
9488     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
9489   } else {
9490     UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
9491     Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
9492 
9493     QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
9494     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
9495       = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
9496                             : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
9497 
9498     // Add overload candidates
9499     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc());
9500 
9501     // FIXME: avoid copy.
9502     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
9503     if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
9504       UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
9505       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
9506     }
9507 
9508     for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
9509            E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
9510 
9511       NamedDecl *Func = *I;
9512       CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
9513       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
9514         Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
9515 
9516 
9517       // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
9518       if (getLangOptions().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
9519         AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args, NumArgs,
9520                              CandidateSet);
9521       } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
9522         // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
9523         // non-template member function.
9524         if (TemplateArgs)
9525           continue;
9526 
9527         AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
9528                            ObjectClassification,
9529                            Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
9530                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
9531       } else {
9532         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func),
9533                                    I.getPair(), ActingDC, TemplateArgs,
9534                                    ObjectType,  ObjectClassification,
9535                                    Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
9536                                    /*SuppressUsedConversions=*/false);
9537       }
9538     }
9539 
9540     DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
9541 
9542     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
9543 
9544     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
9545     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getLocStart(),
9546                                             Best)) {
9547     case OR_Success:
9548       Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
9549       MarkDeclarationReferenced(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), Method);
9550       FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
9551       CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
9552       DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc());
9553       break;
9554 
9555     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
9556       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
9557            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
9558         << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
9559       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
9560       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
9561       return ExprError();
9562 
9563     case OR_Ambiguous:
9564       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
9565         << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
9566       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
9567       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
9568       return ExprError();
9569 
9570     case OR_Deleted:
9571       Diag(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(), diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
9572         << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9573         << DeclName
9574         << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
9575         << MemExprE->getSourceRange();
9576       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
9577       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
9578       return ExprError();
9579     }
9580 
9581     MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
9582 
9583     // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
9584     // non-member call based on that function.
9585     if (Method->isStatic()) {
9586       return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc,
9587                                    Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
9588     }
9589 
9590     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
9591   }
9592 
9593   QualType ResultType = Method->getResultType();
9594   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
9595   ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
9596 
9597   assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
9598   CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall =
9599     new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, MemExprE, Args, NumArgs,
9600                                     ResultType, VK, RParenLoc);
9601 
9602   // Check for a valid return type.
9603   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
9604                           TheCall, Method))
9605     return ExprError();
9606 
9607   // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
9608   // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
9609   // it was done at lookup.
9610   if (!Method->isStatic()) {
9611     ExprResult ObjectArg =
9612       PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
9613                                           FoundDecl, Method);
9614     if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
9615       return ExprError();
9616     MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.take());
9617   }
9618 
9619   // Convert the rest of the arguments
9620   const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
9621     Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9622   if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
9623                               RParenLoc))
9624     return ExprError();
9625 
9626   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
9627     return ExprError();
9628 
9629   if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
9630        isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
9631       TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
9632     const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
9633 
9634     if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
9635       Diag(MemExpr->getLocStart(),
9636            diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
9637         << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
9638         << MD->getParent()->getDeclName();
9639 
9640       Diag(MD->getLocStart(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
9641     }
9642   }
9643   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
9644 }
9645 
9646 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
9647 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
9648 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
9649 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
9650 ExprResult
9651 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
9652                                    SourceLocation LParenLoc,
9653                                    Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
9654                                    SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
9655   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
9656     return ExprError();
9657   ExprResult Object = Owned(Obj);
9658 
9659   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
9660   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, NumArgs, UnbridgedCasts))
9661     return ExprError();
9662 
9663   assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() && "Requires object type argument");
9664   const RecordType *Record = Object.get()->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
9665 
9666   // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
9667   //  If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
9668   //  evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
9669   //  candidate functions includes at least the function call
9670   //  operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
9671   //  ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
9672   //  (E).operator().
9673   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc);
9674   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
9675 
9676   if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
9677                           PDiag(diag::err_incomplete_object_call)
9678                           << Object.get()->getSourceRange()))
9679     return true;
9680 
9681   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
9682   LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
9683   R.suppressDiagnostics();
9684 
9685   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
9686        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
9687     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
9688                        Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet,
9689                        /*SuppressUserConversions=*/ false);
9690   }
9691 
9692   // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
9693   //   In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
9694   //   declared in T of the form
9695   //
9696   //        operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
9697   //
9698   //   where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
9699   //   greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
9700   //   denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
9701   //   R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
9702   //   (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
9703   //   of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
9704   //   is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
9705   //   surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
9706   //   functions for each conversion function declared in an
9707   //   accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
9708   //   within T by another intervening declaration.
9709   const UnresolvedSetImpl *Conversions
9710     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
9711   for (UnresolvedSetImpl::iterator I = Conversions->begin(),
9712          E = Conversions->end(); I != E; ++I) {
9713     NamedDecl *D = *I;
9714     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
9715     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
9716       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
9717 
9718     // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
9719     // surrogates.
9720     if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
9721       continue;
9722 
9723     CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
9724     if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
9725       // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
9726       // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
9727       QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
9728       if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
9729         ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
9730 
9731       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
9732       {
9733         AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
9734                               Object.get(), Args, NumArgs, CandidateSet);
9735       }
9736     }
9737   }
9738 
9739   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9740 
9741   // Perform overload resolution.
9742   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
9743   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getLocStart(),
9744                              Best)) {
9745   case OR_Success:
9746     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
9747     // below.
9748     break;
9749 
9750   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
9751     if (CandidateSet.empty())
9752       Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
9753         << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
9754         << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
9755     else
9756       Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
9757            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
9758         << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
9759     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
9760     break;
9761 
9762   case OR_Ambiguous:
9763     Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
9764          diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
9765       << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
9766     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
9767     break;
9768 
9769   case OR_Deleted:
9770     Diag(Object.get()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
9771          diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
9772       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9773       << Object.get()->getType()
9774       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
9775       << Object.get()->getSourceRange();
9776     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, NumArgs);
9777     break;
9778   }
9779 
9780   if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
9781     return true;
9782 
9783   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
9784 
9785   if (Best->Function == 0) {
9786     // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
9787     // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
9788     CXXConversionDecl *Conv
9789       = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
9790                          Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
9791 
9792     CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
9793     DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
9794 
9795     // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
9796     // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
9797     // on the object argument, then let ActOnCallExpr finish the job.
9798 
9799     // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
9800     // and then call it.
9801     ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
9802                                              Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
9803     if (Call.isInvalid())
9804       return ExprError();
9805 
9806     return ActOnCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, MultiExprArg(Args, NumArgs),
9807                          RParenLoc);
9808   }
9809 
9810   MarkDeclarationReferenced(LParenLoc, Best->Function);
9811   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), 0, Best->FoundDecl);
9812   DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc);
9813 
9814   // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
9815   // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
9816   // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
9817   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
9818   const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
9819     Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
9820 
9821   unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
9822   unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
9823 
9824   // Build the full argument list for the method call (the
9825   // implicit object parameter is placed at the beginning of the
9826   // list).
9827   Expr **MethodArgs;
9828   if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
9829     NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
9830     MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgsInProto + 1];
9831   } else {
9832     MethodArgs = new Expr*[NumArgs + 1];
9833   }
9834   MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
9835   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx)
9836     MethodArgs[ArgIdx + 1] = Args[ArgIdx];
9837 
9838   ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method,
9839                                            HadMultipleCandidates);
9840   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
9841     return true;
9842 
9843   // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly
9844   // owned.
9845   QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
9846   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
9847   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
9848 
9849   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
9850     new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Call, NewFn.take(),
9851                                       MethodArgs, NumArgs + 1,
9852                                       ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc);
9853   delete [] MethodArgs;
9854 
9855   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), LParenLoc, TheCall,
9856                           Method))
9857     return true;
9858 
9859   // We may have default arguments. If so, we need to allocate more
9860   // slots in the call for them.
9861   if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto)
9862     TheCall->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto + 1);
9863   else if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto)
9864     NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
9865 
9866   bool IsError = false;
9867 
9868   // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
9869   ExprResult ObjRes =
9870     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/0,
9871                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
9872   if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
9873     IsError = true;
9874   else
9875     Object = move(ObjRes);
9876   TheCall->setArg(0, Object.take());
9877 
9878   // Check the argument types.
9879   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
9880     Expr *Arg;
9881     if (i < NumArgs) {
9882       Arg = Args[i];
9883 
9884       // Pass the argument.
9885 
9886       ExprResult InputInit
9887         = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
9888                                                     Context,
9889                                                     Method->getParamDecl(i)),
9890                                     SourceLocation(), Arg);
9891 
9892       IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
9893       Arg = InputInit.takeAs<Expr>();
9894     } else {
9895       ExprResult DefArg
9896         = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
9897       if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
9898         IsError = true;
9899         break;
9900       }
9901 
9902       Arg = DefArg.takeAs<Expr>();
9903     }
9904 
9905     TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg);
9906   }
9907 
9908   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
9909   if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
9910     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
9911     for (unsigned i = NumArgsInProto; i != NumArgs; i++) {
9912       ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod, 0);
9913       IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
9914       TheCall->setArg(i + 1, Arg.take());
9915     }
9916   }
9917 
9918   if (IsError) return true;
9919 
9920   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall))
9921     return true;
9922 
9923   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
9924 }
9925 
9926 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
9927 ///  (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
9928 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
9929 ExprResult
9930 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
9931   assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
9932          "left-hand side must have class type");
9933 
9934   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
9935     return ExprError();
9936 
9937   SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
9938 
9939   // C++ [over.ref]p1:
9940   //
9941   //   [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
9942   //   for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
9943   //   the operator is selected as the best match function by the
9944   //   overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
9945   DeclarationName OpName =
9946     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
9947   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc);
9948   const RecordType *BaseRecord = Base->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
9949 
9950   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
9951                           PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
9952                             << Base->getSourceRange()))
9953     return ExprError();
9954 
9955   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
9956   LookupQualifiedName(R, BaseRecord->getDecl());
9957   R.suppressDiagnostics();
9958 
9959   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
9960        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
9961     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
9962                        0, 0, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
9963   }
9964 
9965   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
9966 
9967   // Perform overload resolution.
9968   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
9969   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
9970   case OR_Success:
9971     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
9972     break;
9973 
9974   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
9975     if (CandidateSet.empty())
9976       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
9977         << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
9978     else
9979       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
9980         << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
9981     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
9982     return ExprError();
9983 
9984   case OR_Ambiguous:
9985     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
9986       << "->" << Base->getType() << Base->getSourceRange();
9987     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_ViableCandidates, &Base, 1);
9988     return ExprError();
9989 
9990   case OR_Deleted:
9991     Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
9992       << Best->Function->isDeleted()
9993       << "->"
9994       << getDeletedOrUnavailableSuffix(Best->Function)
9995       << Base->getSourceRange();
9996     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, &Base, 1);
9997     return ExprError();
9998   }
9999 
10000   MarkDeclarationReferenced(OpLoc, Best->Function);
10001   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, 0, Best->FoundDecl);
10002   DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, OpLoc);
10003 
10004   // Convert the object parameter.
10005   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
10006   ExprResult BaseResult =
10007     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/0,
10008                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
10009   if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
10010     return ExprError();
10011   Base = BaseResult.take();
10012 
10013   // Build the operator call.
10014   ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method,
10015                                             HadMultipleCandidates);
10016   if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
10017     return ExprError();
10018 
10019   QualType ResultTy = Method->getResultType();
10020   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
10021   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
10022   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
10023     new (Context) CXXOperatorCallExpr(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.take(),
10024                                       &Base, 1, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc);
10025 
10026   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getResultType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
10027                           Method))
10028           return ExprError();
10029 
10030   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
10031 }
10032 
10033 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
10034 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
10035 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
10036 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
10037 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
10038 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
10039                                            FunctionDecl *Fn) {
10040   if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
10041     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
10042                                                    Found, Fn);
10043     if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
10044       return PE;
10045 
10046     return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
10047   }
10048 
10049   if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
10050     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
10051                                                    Found, Fn);
10052     assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
10053                                SubExpr->getType()) &&
10054            "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
10055     assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
10056     if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
10057       return ICE;
10058 
10059     return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(),
10060                                     ICE->getCastKind(),
10061                                     SubExpr, 0,
10062                                     ICE->getValueKind());
10063   }
10064 
10065   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
10066     assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
10067            "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
10068     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
10069       if (Method->isStatic()) {
10070         // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
10071         // from non-member functions.
10072       } else {
10073         // Fix the sub expression, which really has to be an
10074         // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
10075         // or template.
10076         Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
10077                                                        Found, Fn);
10078         if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
10079           return UnOp;
10080 
10081         assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
10082                && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
10083         assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
10084                && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
10085 
10086         // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
10087         // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
10088         // appropriate pointer to member type.
10089         QualType ClassType
10090           = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
10091         QualType MemPtrType
10092           = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
10093 
10094         return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType,
10095                                            VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
10096                                            UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
10097       }
10098     }
10099     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
10100                                                    Found, Fn);
10101     if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
10102       return UnOp;
10103 
10104     return new (Context) UnaryOperator(SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
10105                                      Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
10106                                        VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
10107                                        UnOp->getOperatorLoc());
10108   }
10109 
10110   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
10111     // FIXME: avoid copy.
10112     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10113     if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10114       ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10115       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10116     }
10117 
10118     DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
10119                                            ULE->getQualifierLoc(),
10120                                            Fn,
10121                                            ULE->getNameLoc(),
10122                                            Fn->getType(),
10123                                            VK_LValue,
10124                                            Found.getDecl(),
10125                                            TemplateArgs);
10126     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
10127     return DRE;
10128   }
10129 
10130   if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
10131     // FIXME: avoid copy.
10132     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = 0;
10133     if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
10134       MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
10135       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
10136     }
10137 
10138     Expr *Base;
10139 
10140     // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
10141     // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
10142     if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
10143       if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
10144         DeclRefExpr *DRE = DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
10145                                                MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
10146                                                Fn,
10147                                                MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
10148                                                Fn->getType(),
10149                                                VK_LValue,
10150                                                Found.getDecl(),
10151                                                TemplateArgs);
10152         DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
10153         return DRE;
10154       } else {
10155         SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
10156         if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
10157           Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
10158         Base = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
10159                                          MemExpr->getBaseType(),
10160                                          /*isImplicit=*/true);
10161       }
10162     } else
10163       Base = MemExpr->getBase();
10164 
10165     ExprValueKind valueKind;
10166     QualType type;
10167     if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
10168       valueKind = VK_LValue;
10169       type = Fn->getType();
10170     } else {
10171       valueKind = VK_RValue;
10172       type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
10173     }
10174 
10175     MemberExpr *ME = MemberExpr::Create(Context, Base,
10176                                         MemExpr->isArrow(),
10177                                         MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(),
10178                                         Fn,
10179                                         Found,
10180                                         MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
10181                                         TemplateArgs,
10182                                         type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary);
10183     ME->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
10184     return ME;
10185   }
10186 
10187   llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
10188   return E;
10189 }
10190 
10191 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
10192                                                 DeclAccessPair Found,
10193                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
10194   return Owned(FixOverloadedFunctionReference((Expr *)E.get(), Found, Fn));
10195 }
10196 
10197 } // end namespace clang
10198